Specifiers Guide Chapter 14 105476 Catalog
57343-Catalog 57343-Catalog 57343-Catalog 783510 Batch8 unilog cesco-content
57343-Catalog 57343-Catalog 57343-Catalog Batch8 unilog cesco-content
2014-09-05
: Pdf 105476-Catalog 105476-Catalog 783510 Batch7 unilog
Open the PDF directly: View PDF .
Page Count: 132
Download | |
Open PDF In Browser | View PDF |
: CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se PH (763) (763) 422-2600 422-2211 FX 14 CHAPTER Accessories Featured Products in this Chapter ▶ H2OMIT™ Vent Drains, Type 4X P. 1290 ▶ H2OMIT™ Thermoelectric Dehumidifier P. 1292 ▶ Pressure Compensation Device P. 1295 ▶ HOL-SEALERS™ Non-Metallic Hole Seals P. 1342 ® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 P. 1384 ▶ INTERSAFE 1286 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products : CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se CHAPTER CONTENTS Condensation and Pressure Compensation Condensation and Pressure Compensation Devices H2OMIT® Vent Drains, Type 4X . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H2OMIT® Thermoelectric Dehumidifier. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Stainless Steel Pressure Compensation Device. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pressure Compensation Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates 1290 1292 1294 1295 Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Perforated Panels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1296 Panels for Junction Boxes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1298 Composite Panels for Junction Boxes and UL/NEMA Wall-Mount Enclosures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1299 Junction Box and Wall-Mount Enclosure Swing-Out Panel Kit. . . . 1300 Panels for Type 1 Enclosures and Small Type 3R Enclosures . . . . . . 1301 Panels for Medium Type 1 Enclosures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1301 Panels for Type 3R, 4, 4X, 12 and 13 Enclosures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1302 Panels for Large Bulletin A27, A28, A28S4 and A34 Multi-Door Enclosures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1304 Panels for Free-Stand Type 1 Large One-Door Enclosures. . . . . . . . 1305 Panels for Free-Stand Type 1 Large Two-Door Enclosures. . . . . . . . 1305 Panels for Free-Stand Type 4, 4X and 12 Single- and Dual-Access One-Door Enclosures with Mounting Channel. . . . . 1306 Panels for Free-Stand Type 4, 4X and 12 Single- and Dual-Access Two-Door Enclosures with Mounting Channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1307 Side-Mounted Panels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1308 Heavy Duty Panel Supports. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1308 Center Panel Supports. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1309 Swing-Out Panels for Free-Stand Type 4, 4X and 12 Enclosures with Mounting Channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1311 Panels for WiFi Cabinets and Small Wall-Mount Enclosures . . . . . . 1311 Panels for Open Frame Racks Rack Panel for 19-in. Racks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1312 Tool-less (Snap-in) Blanking Panels for 19-in. Racks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1312 Rack Panels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1313 Panel Accessories Panel Lifting Hooks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1314 Panel Support Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1314 Window Kits Window Kits Steel and Stainless Steel Window Kits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1315 Wing Knobs for CONCEPT® Window Kits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1316 Frameless Window Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1316 CONCEPT® Fixed and Hinged Window Kits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1316 Type 12 Hinged Window Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1317 CONCEPT® Deep Hinged Window Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1317 Type 4 and 4X Deep-Hinged Window Kits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1318 Door Accessories Door Stops Door Stop Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1320 Type 316 Stainless Steel Door Stop Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1320 Large Enclosure Door Stop Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1320 Data Pockets Thermoplastic Data Pocket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1321 Metal Data Pocket. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1321 External Data Pockets, Type 4/4X/12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1322 Subject to change without notice Folding Shelves Stainless Steel Folding Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1324 Large Folding Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1324 Shelves for Open Frame Racks Double-Sided Solid Aluminum Shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1325 Double-Sided, Solid Aluminum, Heavy Duty Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1325 Single-Sided Solid Aluminum Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1325 Single-Sided Solid-Steel Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1325 Single-Sided Steel Vented Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1326 Double-Sided Solid-Steel Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1326 Double-Sided Steel Vented Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1326 Center-Mount Steel Shelves. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1326 Rack-Mount Steel Shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1327 Adjustable Steel Vented Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1327 Pullout Keyboard Tray with Monitor Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1327 Pull-Out Shelf for Mini Keyboard. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1327 Shelves for Racks and Cabinets Pivoting Keyboard Shelf with Mouse Tray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1328 Steel Keyboard/Monitor Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1328 Pull-Out Shelf for Mini Keyboard. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1328 Rack-Mount Adjustable Shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1329 Tool-less Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1329 Single-Sided Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1330 Sliding Equipment Shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1330 Cable Manager Arm for Sliding Equipment Shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1330 Keyboard Compartment for 19-in. Racks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1331 Writing Surface for Rack-Angle-Mounted Drawer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1331 Rack-Angle Mounted Drawer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1331 Fixed Shelf. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1332 19-in. Fixed Shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1332 Pull-Out Shelves. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1332 Drawers Drawers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1333 CONCEPT® Keyboard Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1333 Gland Plates 16 Gauge Gland Plate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1334 12 Gauge Gland Plate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1334 Locks, Lockouts, Latches, Handles and Clamps Locks Padlock Kit for Junction Boxes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacement Keys. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lock Kit for Clamp Cover Junction Boxes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lock Kit for Type 3R and 12 Enclosures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lockouts Safety Lockouts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dual-Access Safety Lockouts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Latches T-Handle Latch and Keyed Cylinder Lock Kits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Toggle Latch for Type 4 and 4X Floor-Mount and Free-Stand Enclosures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Latch Kit for One-Door Type 12 Enclosures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Latch Kits for Type 4 and 12 Enclosures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com 1336 1336 1336 1336 1337 1337 1338 1338 1338 1338 Continued on next page © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1287 Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se PH (763) (763) 422-2600 422-2211 FX CHAPTER CONTENTS CONTINUED Handles POWERGLIDE® Handles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Handle Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . POWERGLIDE® Defeater Handle Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Handles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clamps Fast-Operating Clamp-Cover Junction Box Clamp. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fast-Operating Clamp Assembly. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clamp Kits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clamp Block Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1339 1339 1339 1339 1340 1340 1340 1340 Drip Shields Drip Shields Drip Shield Kit for Type 12 Enclosures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1341 Stainless Steel Drip Shield Kit for Type 4 and 4X Wall-Mount Enclosures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1341 Hole Seals Hole Seals HOL-SEALERS® Hole Seals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1342 HOL-SEALERS® Non-Metallic Hole Seals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1344 Corrosion Inhibitors Corrosion Inhibitors Industrial Corrosion Inhibitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1346 Epoxy Patch Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1347 Touch-Up Paint. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1347 Electrical Accessories Terminal Block Kits Terminal Block Kit Assembly for Junction Boxes Overview. . . . . . . Terminal Block Bracket Assemblies for Junction Boxes. . . . . . . . . . . Terminal Box Straps for Junction Boxes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Terminal Block Strips for Junction Boxes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bracket Assembly for Type 4, 12 and 13 Enclosures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Terminal Block Kit Assembly for Type 4, 12 and 13 Enclosures Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Terminal Straps for Type 4, 12 and 13 Enclosures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Terminal Strap Support Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Grounding DIN Type Rails . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Grounding Device. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Grounding Bar System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ® PROLINE Grounding Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electrical Interlocks Electrical Interlocks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electrical Interlock Defeater. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Panel Interface Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lighting Packages PANELITE™ Enclosure Lights Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANELITE™ LED Enclosure Light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANELITE™ Fluorescent Enclosure Light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANELITE™ Power Cords . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANELITE™ Power Cable with Leads. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANELITE™ Ganging Cables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANELITE™ Door Switch Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANELITE™ Remote Door Switches. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PANELITE™ Wiring Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mounting Bracket Kit for Light Package . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Remote Switches for Light Package . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1288 Subject to change without notice 14 : CHS Controls AB 1348 1349 1349 1349 1350 1350 1351 1351 1352 1352 1352 1353 1354 1356 1356 1358 1359 1359 1360 1360 1360 1360 1361 1361 1362 1362 Power Distribution Units Rack- and Panel-Mount Power Distribution Units (PDUs) . . . . . . . . IEC Cord Sets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IEC C-13 Retaining Clip. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rack-Mount PDU Bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1364 1365 1365 1365 Mounting Accessories Mounting Kits Mounting Bracket Kits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1366 ULTRX® Mounting Bracket Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1366 Pole-Mount Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1366 Bottom Support Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1367 Unistrut Mounting Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1367 Enclosure Stabilizers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1367 Floor Stand Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1368 Legs and Casters Caster Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1370 Plate Casters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1370 Sanitary Leg Kits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1371 Stainless Steel Legs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1371 Fasteners Screw Packages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1372 VELCRO® Cable Wrap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1372 Tamper-Resistant Screws . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1372 Cage Nut Package. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1373 Clip Nut Package . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1373 PROLINE® Fastener Packages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1373 Fastener Package. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1373 Clamping Nut Package. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1373 Rack-Mount Accessories Guides . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1374 Slides. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1374 Fan Speed Control, Rack-Mount. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1375 Joining Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1375 Panel Adapter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1375 Rack Unit Label. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1376 Mobile Base for Open Frame Racks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1376 19-in. Rack-Mount/Desktop Case, Type 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1377 Swing-Out Rack Mounting Frames. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1378 19-in. and 23-in. Rack Angles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1379 Rack Mounting Angles - U Style (Type RA). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1379 Rack Mounting Angles - L Style (Type RP). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1381 Rack Mounting Angle Kit - L Style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1383 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1384 INTERSAFE® Data Ports for ControlNet Protocol. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1385 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Data Highway Plus Protocol. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1386 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for DeviceNet Protocol. . . . . . . . . 1387 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for DH+, ModBus Plus, Ethernet Protocol. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1388 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Ethernet Protocol. . . . . . . . . . . 1389 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Ethernet/ProfiNet Protocol. 1390 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Genius Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . 1391 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Micro Protocol. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1392 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Modbus Protocol. . . . . . . . . . . 1393 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Profibus Protocol. . . . . . . . . . . 1394 PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products : CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for SNP Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1395 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for USB Protocol, 10-ft. Cable. . . 1396 INTERSAFE® Type 4/4X/12 Data Interface Port Disk Drive Enclosure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1397 To Order a Modified Configuration for INTERSAFE® Type 4/4X/12 Data Interface Ports. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1397 INTERSAFE® Connector 8M. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1398 INTERSAFE® Connector 9FG. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1398 INTERSAFE® Connector 9FT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1398 INTERSAFE® Connector 9M. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1398 INTERSAFE® Connector 9MT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1398 INTERSAFE® Connector 15F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1399 INTERSAFE® Connector 15FT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1399 INTERSAFE® Connector 15H. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1399 INTERSAFE® Connector 15M. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1399 INTERSAFE® Connector 25F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1399 INTERSAFE® Connector 25FT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1400 INTERSAFE® Connector 25M. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1400 INTERSAFE® Connector 25MT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1400 INTERSAFE® Connector BNC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1400 INTERSAFE® Connector CN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1400 INTERSAFE® Connector DH. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1401 INTERSAFE® Connector DNM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1401 INTERSAFE® Connector DNP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1401 INTERSAFE® Connector DPO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1401 INTERSAFE® Connector DP3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1402 INTERSAFE® Connector DP5. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1402 INTERSAFE® Connector ETH. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1402 INTERSAFE® Connector GEG. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1402 INTERSAFE® Connector GFO. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1403 INTERSAFE® Connector GF3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1403 INTERSAFE® Connector GF5. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1403 INTERSAFE® Connector MCL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1404 INTERSAFE® Connector MCL8. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1404 INTERSAFE® Connector MD6. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1404 INTERSAFE® Connector MD8. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1404 INTERSAFE® Connector PB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1405 INTERSAFE® Connector R11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1405 INTERSAFE® Connector RJS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1405 INTERSAFE® Connector SNP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1405 INTERSAFE® Connector SPO. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1406 INTERSAFE® Connector SP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1406 INTERSAFE® Connector SP5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1406 INTERSAFE® Connector TMB. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1406 INTERSAFE® Connector TMM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1407 INTERSAFE® Connector USB. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1407 Wing Knob Latch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1411 DIN3 Type Rails. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1411 Grounding Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1411 DIN Rail or Panel-Mounting Brackets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1411 CONCEPT® Accessories CONCEPT® Accessories CONCEPT® Panel Conversion Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1412 Swing-Out Rack Frame. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1412 Pole-Mount Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1412 Mounting Channels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1412 Rack-Mount Angles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1413 DIN3 Rail Kits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1413 CONCEPT® Panels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1414 CONCEPT® Swing-Out Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1415 CONCEPT® Adapter Bracket. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1415 Handles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1415 Door Stop Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1416 Data Pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1416 Lock Inserts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1416 Mounting-Bracket Kits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1416 Hinge Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1417 Door Bars. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1417 EMC Accessories EMC Accessories Bonding Cable Clamps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1408 EMC Cable Strain Reliefs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1408 Bonding Straps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1408 INLINE® Accessories INLINE® Accessories Lock Inserts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1410 INLINE® Panels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1410 INLINE® Landscape Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1410 Mounting-Bracket Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1410 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1289 Accessories: Condensation and Pressure Compensation Condensation and Pressure Compensation Devices Accessories Condensation and Pressure Compensation Condensation and Pressure Compensation Devices H2OMIT® Vent Drains, Type 4X Industry Standards Features Maintains UL/cUL Type 4, 4X rating when properly installed on a UL/cUL Type 4 or 4X enclosure. •• U ses gravity to remove collected liquids •• One-way mechanical shut-off when pressure is equalized prevents water and contaminants from entering the enclosure •• Helps reduce corrosion that can limit the life of internal electrical and electronic components •• Installs in a 7/8-in. hole in the bottom of enclosure with provided nut or in a 1/2-in. NPT/NPS threaded conduit hub •• Installs in the bottom of mild steel, aluminum, stainless steel or non-metallic enclosures •• Maintains enclosure’s UL Type rating when properly installed UL 508A Listed; Type 4, 4X; File No. E61997 cUL Listed per CSA C22.2 No 94; Type 4, 4X; File No. E61997 NEMA/EEMAC Type 4, 4X Application H2OMIT® Vent Drains allow accumulated water to drain out the bottom of an enclosure. The UL-approved vent drains also function as an air pressure equalizer, reducing the harmful effects of temperature-induced vacuums that could pull water and moisture into the enclosure. Specifications Stainless Steel Vent Drain •• Corrosion-resistant polyester material with a Type 304 stainless steel sleeve •• 2.00-in. long x 1.38-in outside diameter Non-Metallic Drain Vent •• Corrosion-resistant polyester material •• 2.00-in. long x 1.25-in. outside diameter Bulletin: H2O Standard Product Catalog Number AVDR4NM AVDR4SS4 Description Non-metallic Vent Drain Stainless Steel Vent Drain D (in.) 1.25 1.38 D (mm) 32 35 Quantity 1 1 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1290 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Condensation and Pressure Compensation Condensation and Pressure Compensation Devices CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1291 Accessories: Condensation and Pressure Compensation Condensation and Pressure Compensation Devices H2OMIT® Thermoelectric Dehumidifier Industry Standards Specifications •• •• •• •• •• •• •• UL 508A Listed; File No. E61997 cUL Listed per C22.2 No. 14; File No. E61997 CE Application The H2OMIT® Thermoelectric Dehumidifier removes moisture from the air within an enclosure, providing an inexpensive yet highly effective way to protect electronic and electrical components from condensation. Features •• R educes corrosion that can limit the life of internal electrical and electronic components •• Condenses moisture from internal enclosure air and standing liquids •• Built-in drain provision with plastic hose directs collected moisture to the Vent Drain (sold separately) •• Rotating side air vents direct recirculating air away from critical controls •• Mounts via DIN rail on internal panel or mounts directly onto the inside bottom of enclosure above the Vent Drain (sold separately) •• Can be used in mild steel, aluminum, stainless steel and nonmetallic enclosures igh-impact ABS shell H Operates on 24-Volt DC power 4.5 A max. (84 W) Runs continuously above 32 Fa (power supply not included) Removes 8 oz. of moisture in 24 hours Compact 6.00-in. x 5.50-in. x 5.75-in. design One Thermoelectric Dehumidifier includes: - Four feet of plastic hose - Two hose retainers - One double-ended hose retainer - Six inches of Velcro® - Seven-inch strip of DIN rail - Two mounting screws Must be used with UL-certified drain to remove pooled liquid from enclosure. a If continual operation is not desired, a Mechanical Hygrostat (AMHUM) can be wired to the thermoelectric dehumidifier and then set to turn the dehumidifier on at the desired relative humidity. VELCRO is a trademark of Velcro Industries B.V. Bulletin: H2O Standard Product Catalog Number H2OMITTER Description Thermoelectric Dehumidifier CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1292 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Condensation and Pressure Compensation Condensation and Pressure Compensation Devices Dew Point Temperature Percent Relative Humidity Temp. (° F) 110 105 100 95 90 85 80 75 70 65 60 55 50 45 40 35 32 100% 110 105 100 95 90 85 80 75 70 65 60 55 50 45 40 35 32 95% 108 103 99 96 88 83 78 73 68 63 58 53 48 43 39 34 — 90% 106 101 97 92 87 81 77 72 67 62 57 52 46 42 37 32 — 85% 104 99 95 90 85 80 75 70 65 60 55 50 45 40 35 — — 80% 102 97 93 88 83 78 73 68 63 59 53 49 44 39 34 — — 75% 100 95 91 86 81 76 71 66 61 57 52 47 42 37 32 — — 70% 98 93 89 87 79 74 69 64 59 55 50 45 40 35 — — — 65% 95 91 86 81 76 71 67 62 58 53 48 43 38 34 — — — 60% 93 88 84 79 74 69 65 60 55 50 45 40 36 32 — — — 55% 90 85 81 76 71 67 62 58 53 48 43 38 34 — — — — 50% 87 83 78 73 68 64 59 55 50 45 41 36 32 — — — — 45% 84 80 75 70 65 61 56 52 47 42 38 33 — — — — — 40% 80 76 71 67 62 58 53 49 44 40 35 32 — — — — — 35% 76 72 67 63 59 54 50 45 40 36 32 — — — — — — 30% 72 67 63 59 54 50 45 41 37 62 — — — — — — — 25% 65 62 58 54 49 45 40 36 32 — — — — — — — — 20% 60 55 52 48 43 38 35 32 — — — — — — — — — 15% 51 47 44 40 36 32 32 — — — — — — — — — — 10% 41 37 32 32 32 — — — — — — — — — — — — Definition: Dew Point is the temperature at which condensation forms. If the temperature of the enclosure is 85 F and the relative humidity is 80 percent, Dew Point is reached at a temperature of 78 F or below. This means that moisture vapor will condense on any surface that is below the Dew Point temperature of 78 F. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1293 Accessories: Condensation and Pressure Compensation Condensation and Pressure Compensation Devices Stainless Steel Pressure Compensation Device Specifications •• T ype 316L stainless steel •• Semipermeable membrane inside the plug filters moisture and dust •• Mounting thread M40 with union nut Finish Machined Type 316L stainless steel Bulletin: D85 Standard Product Catalog Number APCDSS6 Industry Standards CE NEMA Type 4X IEC/EN 60529, IP66 AxB in./mm 2.28 x 1.22 58 x 31 Depth in Enclosure in./mm 0.35 9 Operating/Storage Temperature °F -40 to 176 Operating/Storage Temperature °C -40 to 80 A dimension = diameter Application Pressure differentials in a tightly sealed enclosure result from heat generated by electrical and electronic equipment within the enclosure and fluctuations of outside ambient temperature. Stainless steel pressure compensation devices provide IP66 protection in corrosive applications requiring slow pressure equalization. For optimal performance, install two plugs diagonally to each other. Features •• A ir permeability = 42 cubic feet/hour (1,200 liters/hour) at a pressure difference of min. 70 mbar •• Easy installation: drill one 1.60-in. (41-mm) diameter hole •• Sealing gasket (Nitrile Buna-N Rubber) CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1294 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Condensation and Pressure Compensation Condensation and Pressure Compensation Devices Pressure Compensation Device Finish Light-gray plastic. Polymeric material manufactured by DuPont™. DuPont is the trademark of E. I. duPont de Nemours and Company. Bulletin: D85 Standard Product Catalog Number APCDABS Depth in Enclosure in./mm 0.6 15 Operating/Storage Temperature °F -49 to 158 Operating/Storage Temperature °C -45 to 70 A dimension = diameter Industry Standards UL Type 1, 4, 4X; File No. E234324 CE IEC/EN 60529, IP66 Application Pressure differentials in a tightly sealed enclosure result from heat generated by electrical and electronic equipment within the enclosure and fluctuations of outside ambient temperature. Pressure compensation devices provide IP66 protection in applications requiring slow pressure equalization. For optimal performance, install two plugs diagonally to each other. Features •• A ir permeability = 42 cubic feet/hour (1,200 liters/hour) at a pressure difference of min. 70 mbar •• Easy installation: drill one 1.60-in. (41-mm) diameter hole •• Sealing gasket (Nitrile Buna-N Rubber) Specifications •• S emipermeable membrane inside the plug to filter moisture and dust •• Mounting thread M40 with union nut •• Plastic PA66 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1295 Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Perforated Panels Perforated panels are 16 gauge steel and accept self-tapping screws and eliminate the need to measure, mark and drill when mounting components. Use for mounting lightweight control components. Bulletin: PNLP Catalog Number A6N6PP A8N6PP A8N8PP A10N8PP A10N10PP A12N10PP A12N12PP A14N12PP A16N12PP A20N12PP A16N12MPP A16N16MPP A16N20MPP A18N18MPP A20N12MPP A20N16MPP A20N20MPP A24N16MPP A24N20MPP A24N24MPP A30N20MPP A30N24MPP A30N30MPP A36N24MPP A36N30MPP A16P12PP A16P16PP A20P16PP A18P18PP A20P20PP A24P20PP A24P24PP A30P24PP A36P24PP A30P30PP A36P30PP A36P36PP Use in Small Type 1 Panel Enclosures and Small Type 3R Boxes Small Type 1 Panel Enclosures and Small Type 3R Boxes Small Type 1 Panel Enclosures and Small Type 3R Boxes Small Type 1 Panel Enclosures and Small Type 3R Boxes Small Type 1 Panel Enclosures and Small Type 3R Boxes Small Type 1 Panel Enclosures and Small Type 3R Boxes Small Type 1 Panel Enclosures and Small Type 3R Boxes Small Type 1 Panel Enclosures and Small Type 3R Boxes Small Type 1 Panel Enclosures and Small Type 3R Boxes Small Type 1 Panel Enclosures and Small Type 3R Boxes Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 1 Panel Enclosures Medium Type 3R Hinged-Cover Panel Enclosures Medium Type 3R Hinged-Cover Panel Enclosures Medium Type 3R Hinged-Cover Panel Enclosures Medium Type 3R Hinged-Cover Panel Enclosures Medium Type 3R Hinged-Cover Panel Enclosures Medium Type 3R Hinged-Cover Panel Enclosures Medium Type 3R Hinged-Cover Panel Enclosures Medium Type 3R Hinged-Cover Panel Enclosures Medium Type 3R Hinged-Cover Panel Enclosures Medium Type 3R Hinged-Cover Panel Enclosures Medium Type 3R Hinged-Cover Panel Enclosures Medium Type 3R Hinged-Cover Panel Enclosures Panel Size D x E (in.) 4.25 x 4.25 6.25 x 4.25 6.25 x 6.25 8.25 x 6.25 8.25 x 8.25 10.25 x 8.25 10.25 x 10.25 12.25 x 10.25 14.25 x 10.25 18.25 x 10.25 10.50 x 13.00 14.50 x 13.00 18.50 x 13.00 16.50 x 15.00 10.50 x 17.00 14.50 x 17.00 18.50 x 17.00 14.50 x 21.00 18.50 x 21.00 22.50 x 21.00 18.50 x 26.00 22.50 x 26.00 28.50 x 26.00 22.50 x 32.00 26.50 x 32.00 13.00 x 9.00 13.00 x 13.00 17.00 x 13.00 15.00 x 15.00 17.00 x 17.00 21.00 x 17.00 21.00 x 21.00 27.00 x 21.00 33.00 x 21.00 27.00 x 27.00 33.00 x 27.00 33.00 x 33.00 Panel Size D x E (mm) 108 x 108 159 x 108 159 x 159 210 x 159 210 x 210 260 x 210 260 x 260 311 x 260 362 x 260 464 x 260 267 x 330 368 x 330 470 x 330 419 x 381 267 x 432 368 x 432 470 x 432 368 x 533 470 x 533 572 x 533 470 x 660 572 x 660 724 x 660 572 x 813 724 x 813 330 x 229 330 x 330 432 x 330 381 x 381 432 x 732 533 x 432 533 x 533 686 x 533 838 x 533 686 x 686 838 x 686 838 x 838 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1296 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1297 Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Panels for Junction Boxes Steel panels are 14 gauge, finished with white polyester powder paint or with a conductive, corrosion-resistant coating. Stainless steel panels are 14 gauge Type 304 and have a commercial #2B finish which is protected on one side with a plastic film. Aluminum panels are 5052-H32 aluminum alloy 0.080-in. (2-mm) thick and protected on one side with a plastic film. Panel mounting hardware is furnished with all enclosures which accept these panels. Bulletin: PNLJ, PNLWM Catalog Number A6P4 A6P4G A6P4SS A6P4AL A6P6 A6P6G A6P6SS A6P6AL A8P6 A8P6G A8P6SS A8P6AL A8P8 A8P8AL A10P8 A10P8G A10P8SS A10P8AL A10P10 A10P10G A10P10AL A12P6 A12P6G A12P10 A12P10G A12P10SS A12P10AL A12P12 A12P12G A12P12SS A14P8 A14P8G A14P12 A14P12G A14P12SS A14P12AL A16P10 A16P10G A16P14 A16P14G A16P14SS A16P14AL A18P16 A18P16G A18P16SS A18P16AL Material Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Panel Size D x E (in.) 4.88 x 2.88 4.88 x 2.88 4.88 x 2.88 4.88 x 2.88 4.88 x 4.88 4.88 x 4.88 4.88 x 4.88 4.88 x 4.88 6.75 x 4.88 6.75 x 4.88 6.75 x 4.88 6.75 x 4.88 6.75 x 6.88 6.75 x 6.88 8.75 x 6.88 8.75 x 6.88 8.75 x 6.88 8.75 x 6.88 8.75 x 8.88 8.75 x 8.88 8.75 x 8.88 10.75 x 4.88 10.75 x 4.88 10.75 x 8.88 10.75 x 8.88 10.75 x 8.88 10.75 x 8.88 10.75 x 10.88 10.75 x 10.88 10.75 x 10.88 12.75 x 6.88 12.75 x 6.88 12.75 x 10.88 12.75 x 10.88 12.75 x 10.88 12.75 x 10.88 14.75 x 8.88 14.75 x 8.88 14.75 x 12.88 14.75 x 12.88 14.75 x 12.88 14.75 x 12.88 16.75 x 14.88 16.75 x 14.88 16.75 x 14.88 16.75 x 14.88 Panel Size D x E (mm) 124 x 73 124 x 73 124 x 73 124 x 73 124 x 124 124 x 124 124 x 124 124 x 124 171 x 124 171 x 124 171 x 124 171 x 124 171 x 175 171 x 175 222 x 175 222 x 175 222 x 175 222 x 175 222 x 226 222 x 226 222 x 226 273 x 124 273 x 124 273 x 226 273 x 226 273 x 226 273 x 226 273 x 276 273 x 276 273 x 276 324 x 175 324 x 175 324 x 276 324 x 276 324 x 276 324 x 276 375 x 226 375 x 226 375 x 327 375 x 327 375 x 327 375 x 327 425 x 378 425 x 378 425 x 378 425 x 378 V (in.) 0.31 0.31 0.31 0.31 0.31 0.31 0.31 0.31 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 V (mm) 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1298 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Composite Panels for Junction Boxes and UL/NEMA Wall-Mount Enclosures Manufactured from light-brown, reinforced phenolic laminate sheet stock. This material has exceptional strength and chemical resistance, which makes it ideally suited for the most corrosive environments. Composite panels are intended for use in corrosion-resistant enclosures. Panel sizes are available for junction boxes and UL/NEMA size enclosures. Composite panels may be drilled and tapped but work equally as well with self-threading or thread-cutting screws. Refer to the table for recommended mounting specifications. Bulletin: PNLC Standard Product Panel Size DxE in./mm 4.88 x 2.88 124 x 73 4.88 x 4.88 124 x 124 6.75 x 4.88 171 x 124 8.75 x 6.88 222 x 175 10.75 x 8.88 273 x 226 12.75 x 10.88 324 x 276 14.75 x 12.88 375 x 327 16.75 x 14.88 425 x 379 17.00 x 13.00 432 x 330 17.00 x 17.00 432 x 432 21.00 x 17.00 533 x 432 21.00 x 21.00 533 x 533 27.00 x 21.00 686 x 533 Catalog Number A6P4C A6P6C A8P6C A10P8C A12P10C A14P12C A16P14C A18P16C A20P16C A20P20C A24P20C A24P24C A30P24C R in./mm 4.25 108 4.25 108 6.25 159 8.25 210 10.25 260 12.25 311 14.25 362 16.25 413 15.25 387 15.25 387 19.25 489 19.25 489 25.25 641 S in./mm 2.25 57 4.25 108 4.25 108 6.25 159 8.25 210 10.25 260 12.25 311 14.25 362 11.25 286 15.25 387 15.25 387 19.25 489 19.25 489 Panel Thickness in./mm 0.12 3 0.12 3 0.12 3 0.12 3 0.19 5 0.19 5 0.19 5 0.19 5 0.19 5 0.19 5 0.19 5 0.19 5 0.19 5 Hole Dia. in./mm 0.25 6 0.25 6 0.25 6 0.25 6 0.25 6 0.25 6 0.25 6 0.25 6 0.50 13 0.50 13 0.50 13 0.50 13 0.50 13 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Composite Panel Mounting Recommendations Screw Type Machine (tapped hole) Screw Size 8-32 Machine (tapped hole) 10-32 Machine (tapped hole) 1/4-20 Thread Cutting Type T 8-32 Thread Cutting Type T 10-32 Thread Cutting Type T 1/4-20 Sheet Metal A-B 8-32 Sheet Metal A-B 10-32 Sheet Metal A-B 1/4-20 Subject to change without notice Hole Size in./mm .136 3 .161 4 .204 5 .144 4 .166 4 .288 7 .147 4 .166 4 .221 6 Max. Insertion Torque (lb.) in 0.12 in. Material 15 Max. Insertion Torque (lb.) in 0.19 in. Material 25 Max. Load (lb. per screw) in 0.12 in. Material 40 Max. Load (lb. per screw) in 0.19 in. Material 45 15 25 35 40 20 25 30 35 15 25 40 45 15 25 35 40 20 25 30 35 Not recommended 10 40 45 Not recommended 10 35 40 Not recommended 15 30 35 PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1299 Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Junction Box and Wall-Mount Enclosure Swing-Out Panel Kit Kits allow mounting standard Hoffman junction box and NEMA style panels (purchase separately) near the front of the enclosure for easy access to or reading of gauges, switches, pilot lights and other components. Kits consist of heavy-gauge brackets and hinges which are easily installed by drilling small holes in the sides of the enclosure and bolting the brackets in place. External screws are stainless steel; internal components are plated steel. All mounting hardware and instructions are provided. Sealing washers ensure the enclosure will meet original JIC or NEMA standards after installation. Swing-Out Panel Kits do not fit single-door disconnect enclosures. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number AJCDFK Description Junction Box Kit Maximum Load (lb.) 25 Maximum Load (kg) 11.3 ANADFK Wall-Mount Enclosure Kit 100 45.4 Use In - Junction boxes where A x B is 8.00 x 6.00 in. (203 x 152 mm) or larger - HCLO Type 3R enclosures where A x B is 16.00 x 12.00 in. (406 x 305 mm) or smaller - One-door Type 4, 12 and 13 enclosures where A x B is 12.00 x 12.00 in. (305 x 305 mm) or larger - HCLO Type 3R enclosures where A x B is 16.00 x 16.00 in. (406 x 406 mm) or larger - HCR Type 3R enclosures where A x B is 16.00 x 12.00 (406 x 305 mm) or larger - Type 1 enclosures where A x B is 42.00 x 30.00 in. (1067 x 762 mm) or larger Both kits maintain UL Type 4 rating when properly installed in a Hoffman enclosure. Maximum load includes the weight of the panel plus the weight of the components, with the weight of the components spread evenly over the panel. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1300 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Panels for Type 1 Enclosures and Small Type 3R Enclosures Steel panels are 14 gauge, finished with white polyester powder paint. Panel mounting hardware is furnished with enclosure. Bulletin: PNLT1 Catalog Number A6N4P A6N6P A8N6P A8N8P A10N8P A10N10P A12N10P A12N12P A14N12P A16N12P A20N12P Panel Size D x E (in.) 4.25 x 2.25 4.25 x 4.25 6.25 x 4.25 6.25 x 6.25 8.25 x 6.25 8.25 x 8.25 10.25 x 8.25 10.25 x 10.25 12.25 x 10.25 14.25 x 10.25 18.25 x 10.25 Panel Size D x E (mm) 108 x 57 108 x 108 159 x 108 159 x 159 210 x 159 210 x 210 260 x 210 260 x 260 311 x 260 362 x 260 464 x 260 Panels for Medium Type 1 Enclosures Steel panels are 14 or 12 gauge with a white polyester powder paint finish. Panel mounting hardware is furnished with enclosure. Bulletin: PNLT1 Catalog Number A16N12MP A20N12MP A16N16MP A20N16MP A24N16MP A18N18MP A16N20MP A20N20MP A24N20MP A30N20MP A24N24MP A30N24MP A36N24MP A30N30MP A36N30MP Panel Thickness (ga.) 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 12 12 12 12 12 Panel Size D x E (in.) 13.00 x 10.50 17.00 x 10.50 13.00 x 14.50 17.00 x 14.50 21.00 x 14.50 15.00 x 16.50 13.00 x 18.50 17.00 x 18.50 21.00 x 18.50 26.00 x 18.50 21.00 x 22.50 26.00 x 22.50 32.00 x 22.50 26.00 x 28.50 32.00 x 28.50 Panel Size D x E (mm) 330 x 267 432 x 267 330 x 368 432 x 368 533 x 368 381 x 419 330 x 470 432 x 470 533 x 470 660 x 470 533 x 571 660 x 571 813 x 571 660 x 724 813 x 724 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1301 Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Panels for Type 3R, 4, 4X, 12 and 13 Enclosures Steel panels are 12 gauge, finished with white polyester powder paint or a conductive, corrosion-resistant coating. Larger panels have flanges on two or four sides. Some larger steel panels are 10 gauge and include extra holes for panel lifting. Aluminum panels are 5052-H32 aluminum alloy. Larger panels have flanges on four sides. Aluminum panels are protected on one side with a plastic film. Stainless steel panels are Type 316 stainless steel. Panel mounting hardware is furnished with all enclosures which accept these panels. Bulletin: PNLFS, PNLJ, PNLWM Catalog Number A12P24 A12P24G A16P12 A16P12G A16P12SS6 A16P12AL A16P16 A16P16G A16P16SS6 A16P16AL A18P18 A18P18G A20P12 A20P12G A20P16 A20P16G A20P16SS6 A20P16AL A20P20 A20P20G A20P20SS6 A20P20AL A24P16 A24P16G A24P16SS6 A24P20 A24P20G A24P20SS6 A24P20AL A24P24 A24P24G A24P24SS6 A24P24AL A30P16 A30P16G A30P20 A30P20G A30P20SS6 A30P24 A30P24G A30P24SS6 A30P24AL A30P30 A30P30G A30P30SS6 A36P16 A36P16G A36P24 A36P24G A36P24SS6 A36P24AL A36P30 A36P30G A36P30SS6 A36P30AL A36P36 A36P36G A36P36SS6 A40P24 A40P24G A40P30 A40P30G A42P24 A42P24G A42P30 A42P30G A42P30SS6 A42P36 A42P36G A42P36SS6 A42P42 1302 Material Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Painted steel Panel Size D x E (in.) 9.00 x 21.00 9.00 x 21.00 13.00 x 9.00 13.00 x 9.00 13.00 x 9.00 13.00 x 9.00 13.00 x 13.00 13.00 x 13.00 13.00 x 13.00 13.00 x 13.00 15.00 x 15.00 15.00 x 15.00 17.00 x 9.00 17.00 x 9.00 17.00 x 13.00 17.00 x 13.00 17.00 x 13.00 17.00 x 13.00 17.00 x 17.00 17.00 x 17.00 17.00 x 17.00 17.00 x 17.00 21.00 x 13.00 21.00 x 13.00 21.00 x 13.00 21.00 x 17.00 21.00 x 17.00 21.00 x 17.00 21.00 x 17.00 21.00 x 21.00 21.00 x 21.00 21.00 x 21.00 21.00 x 21.00 27.00 x 13.00 33.00 x 27.00 27.00 x 17.00 27.00 x 17.00 27.00 x 17.00 27.00 x 21.00 27.00 x 21.00 27.00 x 21.00 27.00 x 21.00 27.00 x 27.00 27.00 x 27.00 27.00 x 27.00 33.00 X 13.00 33.00 x 13.00 33.00 x 21.00 33.00 x 21.00 33.00 x 21.00 33.00 x 21.00 33.00 x 27.00 33.00 x 27.00 33.00 x 27.00 33.00 x 27.00 33.00 x 33.00 33.00 x 33.00 33.00 x 33.00 37.00 x 21.00 37.00 x 21.00 37.00 x 29.00 37.00 x 29.00 39.00 x 21.00 39.00 x 21.00 39.00 x 27.00 39.00 x 27.00 39.00 x 27.00 39.00 x 33.00 39.00 x 33.00 39.00 x 33.00 39.00 x 39.00 Subject to change without notice Panel Size D x E (mm) 229 x 533 229 x 533 330 x 229 330 x 229 330 x 229 330 x 229 330 x 330 330 x 330 330 x 330 330 x 330 381 x 381 381 x 381 432 x 229 432 x 229 432 x 330 432 x 330 432 x 330 432 x 330 432 x 432 432 x 432 432 x 432 432 x 432 533 x 330 533 x 330 533 x 330 533 x 432 533 x 432 533 x 432 533 x 432 533 x 533 533 x 533 533 x 533 533 x 533 686 x 330 838 x 686 686 x 432 686 x 432 686 x 432 686 x 533 686 x 533 686 x 533 686 x 533 686 x 686 686 x 686 686 x 686 838 X 330 838 x 330 838 x 533 838 x 533 838 x 533 838 x 533 838 x 686 838 x 686 838 x 686 838 x 686 838 x 838 838 x 838 838 x 838 940 x 533 940 x 533 940 x 737 940 x 737 991 x 533 991 x 533 991 x 686 991 x 686 991 x 686 991 x 838 991 x 838 991 x 838 991 x 991 Panel Gauge or Thickness 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 0.10 in./3 mm 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 0.10 in./3 mm 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 0.10 in./3 mm 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 0.10 in./3 mm 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 0.10 in./3 mm 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 0.10 in./3 mm 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 0.10 in./3 mm 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 0.10 in./3 mm 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 0.10 in./3 mm 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. Edge Flanges None None None None None None None None None None None None None None None None None None None None None None None None None 2 2 2 4 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 4 4 4 2 2 2 2 2 2 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 2 2 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 T (in.) — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com T (mm) — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 Number of Holes 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 8 8 8 6 6 4 (no D dim. center hole) 4 (no D dim. center hole) 6 6 6 6 6 8 8 8 8 © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Catalog Number A42P42G A48P24 A48P24G A48P30 A48P30G A48P36 A48P36G A48P36SS6 A48P36AL A48P42 A48P42G A48P48 A48P48G A54P42 A54P42G A60P24 A60P24G A60P30 A60P30G A60P36 A60P36G A60P36SS6 A60P36AL A60BFP42 A60BFP42G A60P48 A60P48G A60P60 A60P60G A72P36 A72P36G A72P60 A72P60G A72P72 A72P72G Material Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Stainless Steel Aluminum Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Painted steel Conductive steel Panel Size D x E (in.) 39.00 x 39.00 45.00 x 21.00 45.00 x 21.00 45.00 x 27.00 45.00 x 27.00 45.00 x 33.00 45.00 x 33.00 45.00 x 33.00 45.00 x 33.00 45.00 x 39.00 45.00 x 39.00 44.00 x 44.00 44.00 x 44.00 50.00 x 38.00 50.00 x 38.00 57.00 x 21.00 57.00 x 21.00 57.00 x 27.00 57.00 x 27.00 57.00 x 33.00 57.00 x 33.00 57.00 x 33.00 57.00 x 33.00 56.00 x 38.00 56.00 x 38.00 56.00 x 44.00 56.00 x 44.00 56.00 x 56.00 56.00 x 56.00 69.00 x 33.00 69.00 x 33.00 68.00 x 56.00 68.00 x 56.00 68.00 x 68.00 68.00 x 68.00 Panel Size D x E (mm) 991 x 991 1143 x 533 1143 x 533 1143 x 686 1143 x 686 1143 x 838 1143 x 838 1143 x 838 1143 x 838 1143 x 991 1143 x 991 1118 x 1118 1118 x 1118 1270 x 965 1270 x 965 1448 x 533 1448 x 533 1448 x 686 1448 x 686 1448 x 838 1448 x 838 1448 x 838 1448 x 838 1422 x 965 1422 x 965 1422 x 1118 1422 x 1118 1422 x 1422 1422 x 1422 1753 x 838 1753 x 838 1727 x 1422 1727 x 1422 1727 x 1727 1727 x 1727 Panel Gauge or Thickness 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 0.10 in./3 mm 12 ga. 12 ga. 10 ga. 10 ga. 12 ga. 10 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 0.10 in./3 mm 10 ga. 10 ga. 10 ga. 10 ga. 10 ga. 10 ga. 12 ga. 12 ga. 10 ga. 10 ga. 10 ga. 10 ga. Edge Flanges 4 2 2 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 T (in.) 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.88 0.88 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.75 0.88 0.88 0.88 0.88 0.88 0.88 0.75 0.75 0.88 0.88 0.88 0.88 T (mm) 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 22 22 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 22 22 22 22 22 22 19 19 22 22 22 22 Number of Holes 8 6 6 6 6 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 6 6 6 6 8 8 8 8 10 10 12 12 10 10 8 8 12 12 10 10 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1303 Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Panels for Large Bulletin A27, A28, A28S4 and A34 Multi-Door Enclosures Extra panels for large enclosures (Bulletins A27, A28, A28S4 and A34) can be ordered for panel assembly prior to receiving the enclosures (enclosures include panels). Panels are 12 gauge steel with .88-in. (22-mm) flanges on four sides. Finish is white polyester powder paint or a conductive, corrosion-resistant coating. Two extra holes are provided for lifting and installing panels. Mounting hardware included with enclosure. Bulletin: PNLFS Catalog Number A72PM28 A72PM28G A72PM34 A72PM34G A72PM40 A72PM40G A72PM54 A72PM54G A72PM66 A72PM66G A72PM78 A72PM78G A84PM40 A84PM40G A84PM78 A84PM78G A86PM37 A86PM37G A86PM75 A86PM75G A90PM40 A90PM40G A90PM78 A90PM78G Finish Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Panel Size D x E (in.) 60.00 x 21.75 60.00 x 21.75 60.00 x 27.75 60.00 x 27.75 60.00 x 33.75 60.00 x 33.75 60.00 x 48.00 60.00 x 48.00 60.00 x 60.00 60.00 x 60.00 60.00 x 72.00 60.00 x 72.00 72.00 x 33.75 72.00 x 33.75 72.00 x 72.00 72.00 x 72.00 78.00 x 34.00 78.00 x 34.00 78.00 x 70.00 78.00 x 70.00 78.00 x 33.75 78.00 x 33.75 78.00 x 72.00 78.00 x 72.00 Panel Size D x E (mm) 1524 x 552 1524 x 552 1524 x 705 1524 x 705 1524 x 857 1829 x 857 1524 x 1219 1524 x 1219 1524 x 1524 1524 x 1524 1524 x 1829 1524 x 1829 1829 x 857 1829 x 857 1829 x 1829 1829 x 1829 1981 x 864 1981 x 864 1981 x 1778 1981 x 1778 1981 x 857 1981 x 857 1981 x 1829 1981 x 1829 Number of Holes 8 8 8 8 8 8 10 10 10 10 12 12 8 8 12 12 8 8 12 12 8 8 12 12 Fits Enclosure Height 72 in. 72 in. 72 in. 72 in. 72 in. 72 in. 72 in. 72 in. 72 in. 72 in. 72 in. 72 in. 84 in. 84 in. 84 in. 84 in. 86 in. 86 in. 86 in. 86 in. 90 in. 90 in. 90 in. 90 in. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1304 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Panels for Free-Stand Type 1 Large One-Door Enclosures Panels for free-stand Type 1 large one-door standard and disconnect enclosures are 12 gauge steel. Panels have either polyester powder paint finish or a conductive, corrosion-resistant coating. Bulletin: A26P, A38P Catalog Number A37P21N A37P21NG A49P21N A49P21NG A61P21N A73P21N A73P21NG A49P32N A49P32NG A61P32N A61P32NG A73P32N A73P32NG Finish Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Panel Size D x E (in.) 37.16 x 21.50 37.16 x 21.50 49.16 x 21.50 49.16 x 21.50 61.16 x 21.50 73.16 x 21.50 73.16 x 21.50 49.16 x 32.00 49.16 x 32.00 61.16 x 32.00 61.16 x 32.00 73.16 x 32.00 73.16 x 32.00 Panel Size D x E (mm) 944 x 546 944 x 546 1249 x 546 1249 x 546 1553 x 546 1858 x 546 1858 x 546 1249 x 813 1249 x 813 1553 x 813 1553 x 813 1858 x 813 1858 x 813 Panels for Free-Stand Type 1 Large Two-Door Enclosures Panels for free-stand Type 1 large two-door standard and disconnect enclosures are 10 gauge steel. Panels have either polyester powder paint finish or a conductive, corrosion-resistant coating. Bulletin: A38P Catalog Number A37P48N A37P48NG A49P48N A49P48NG A49P68N A49P68NG A61P68N A61P68NG A73P68N A73P68NG Finish Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Panel Size D x E (in.) 37.16 x 48.00 37.16 x 48.00 49.16 x 48.00 49.16 x 48.00 49.16 x 68.00 49.16 x 68.00 61.16 x 68.00 61.16 x 68.00 73.16 x 68.00 73.16 x 68.00 Panel Size D x E (mm) 944 x 1219 944 x 1219 1249 x 1219 1249 x 1219 1249 x 1727 1249 x 1727 1553 x 1727 1553 x 1727 1858 x 1727 1858 x 1727 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1305 Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Panels for Free-Stand Type 4, 4X and 12 Single- and Dual-Access One-Door Enclosures with Mounting Channel Panels for one-door, single-access and one-door, dual-access Free-Stand Type 12 Enclosures, Free-Stand Type 4 Enclosures and One-Door Type 4X Free-Stand Fiberglass Enclosures. Panels are 12 gauge steel and can be positioned anywhere along horizontal mounting channels (see dimension drawing Sections B-B for limitations). Half-length panels can be located in the upper or lower portion of the enclosure. Panels are finished with white polyester powder paint or a conductive, corrosion-resistant coating and furnished with plated mounting hardware. Bulletin: PNL30, PNLFS Catalog Number A60P24F1 A60P24F1G A60P24F2 A60P24F2G A72P24F1 A72P24F1G A72P24F2 A72P24F2G A90P24F1 A90P24F1G A90P24F2 A90P24F2G A72P30F1 A72P30F1G A72P30F2 A72P30F2G A60P36F1 A60P36F1G A60P36F2 A60P36F2G A72P36F1 A72P36F1G A72P36F2 A72P36F2G A90P36F1 A90P36F1G A90P36F2 A90P36F2G Description Full Panel Full Panel Half Panel Half Panel Full Panel Full Panel Half Panel Half Panel Full Panel Full Panel Half Panel Half Panel Full Panel Full Panel Half Panel Half Panel Full Panel Full Panel Half Panel Half Panel Full Panel Full Panel Half Panel Half Panel Full Panel Full Panel Half Panel Half Panel Finish Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Panel Size (in.) 48.00 x 20.00 48.00 x 20.00 24.88 x 20.00 24.88 x 20.00 60.00 x 20.00 60.00 x 20.00 30.88 x 20.00 30.88 x 20.00 78.00 x 20.00 78.00 x 20.00 39.88 x 20.00 39.88 x 20.00 60.00 x 26.00 60.00 x 26.00 30.88 x 26.00 30.88 x 26.00 48.00 x 32.00 48.00 x 32.00 24.88 x 32.00 24.88 x 32.00 60.00 x 32.00 60.00 x 32.00 30.88 x 32.00 30.88 x 32.00 78.00 x 32.00 78.00 x 32.00 39.88 x 32.00 39.88 x 32.00 Panel Size (mm) 1218 x 508 1218 x 508 632 x 508 632 x 508 1524 x 508 1524 x 508 784 x 508 784 x 508 1981 x 508 1981 x 508 1013 x 508 1013 x 508 1524 x 660 1524 x 660 784 x 660 784 x 660 1219 x 813 1219 x 813 632 x 813 632 x 813 1524 x 813 1524 x 813 784 x 813 784 x 813 1981 x 813 1981 x 813 1013 x 813 1013 x 813 Fits Enclosure A x B (in.) 60.00 x 24.00 60.00 x 24.00 60.00 x 24.00 60.00 x 24.00 72.00 x 24.00 72.00 x 24.00 72.00 x 24.00 72.00 x 24.00 90.00 x 24.00 90.00 x 24.00 90.00 x 24.00 90.00 x 24.00 72.00 x 30.00 72.00 x 30.00 72.00 x 30.00 72.00 x 30.00 60.00 x 36.00 60.00 x 36.00 60.00 x 36.00 60.00 x 36.00 72.00 x 36.00 72.00 x 36.00 72.00 x 36.00 72.00 x 36.00 90.00 x 36.00 90.00 x 36.00 90.00 x 36.00 90.00 x 36.00 Fits Enclosure A x B (mm) 1524 x 610 1524 x 610 1524 x 610 1524 x 610 1829 x 610 1829 x 610 1829 x 610 1829 x 610 2286 x 610 2286 x 610 2286 x 610 2286 x 610 1829 x 762 1829 x 762 1829 x 762 1829 x 762 1524 x 914 1524 x 914 1524 x 914 1524 x 914 1829 x 914 1829 x 914 1829 x 914 1829 x 914 2286 x 914 2286 x 914 2286 x 914 2286 x 914 Use combinations of panels for 3-5 door A 28 enclosures. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1306 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Panels for Free-Stand Type 4, 4X and 12 Single- and Dual-Access Two-Door Enclosures with Mounting Channel Panels for two-door single access and two-door dual access Free-Stand Type 4, 4X and 12 Enclosures with mounting channel are 10 gauge steel and can be positioned anywhere along horizontal mounting channels (see Sections B-B for limitations). Half-length panels can be located in the upper or lower portion of the enclosure. Some assembly is required. Panels are finished with white polyester powder paint or a conductive, corrosion-resistant coating and furnished with plated mounting hardware. Center support is furnished with each full panel or half panel for two-door enclosures. The center support attaches to the top and bottom mounting channels and can be positioned from front to back in the enclosure. The center support can be used with heavy duty panel supports to support panels of various heights. Bulletin: PNL30, PNLFS Catalog Number A60P48F1 A60P48F1G A72P48F1 A72P48F1G A72P48F2 A72P48F2G A90P48F1 A90P48F1G A90P48F2 A90P48F2G A72P60F1 A72P60F1G A72P60F2 A72P60F2G A72P72F1 A72P72F1G A72P72F2 A72P72F2G A90P72F1 A90P72F1G A90P72F2 A90P72F2G Description Full Panel Full Panel Full Panel Full Panel Half Panel Half Panel Full Panel Full Panel Half Panel Half Panel Full Panel Full Panel Half Panel Half Panel Full Panel Full Panel Half Panel Half Panel Full Panel Full Panel Half Panel Half Panel Fits Enclosure A x B (in.) 60.00 x 48.00 60.00 x 48.00 72.00 x 48.00 72.00 x 48.00 72.00 x 48.00 72.00 x 48.00 90.00 x 48.00 90.00 x 48.00 90.00 x 48.00 90.00 x 48.00 72.00 x 60.00 72.00 x 60.00 72.00 x 60.00 72.00 x 60.00 72.00 x 72.00 72.00 x 72.00 72.00 x 72.00 72.00 x 72.00 90.00 x 72.00 90.00 x 72.00 90.00 x 72.00 90.00 x 72.00 Fits Enclosure A x B (mm) 1524 x 1219 1524 x 1219 1829 x 1219 1829 x 1219 1829 x 1219 1829 x 1219 2286 x 1219 2286 x 1219 2286 x 1219 2286 x 1219 1829 x 1524 1829 x 1524 1829 x 1524 1829 x 1524 1829 x 1829 1829 x 1829 1829 x 1829 1829 x 1829 2286 x 1829 2286 x 1829 2286 x 1829 2286 x 1829 Panel Size (in.) 48.00 x 44.00 48.00 x 44.00 60.00 x 44.00 60.00 x 44.00 30.88 x 44.00 30.88 x 44.00 78.00 x 44.00 78.00 x 44.00 39.88 x 44.00 39.88 x 44.00 60.00 x 56.00 60.00 x 56.00 30.88 x 56.00 30.88 x 56.00 60.00 x 68.00 60.00 x 68.00 30.88 x 68.00 30.88 x 68.00 78.00 x 68.00 78.00 x 68.00 39.88 x 68.00 39.88 x 68.00 Panel Size (mm) 1219 x 1118 1219 x 1118 1524 x 1118 1524 x 1118 784 x 1118 784 x 1118 1981 x 1118 1981 x 1118 1013 x 1118 1013 x 1118 1524 x 1422 1524 x 1422 784 x 1422 784 x 1422 1524 x 1727 1524 x 1727 784 x 1727 784 x 1727 1981 x 1727 1981 x 1727 1013 x 1727 1013 x 1727 G (in.) 23.12 23.12 29.12 29.12 29.12 29.12 38.12 38.12 38.12 38.12 29.12 29.12 29.12 29.12 29.12 29.12 29.12 29.12 38.12 38.12 38.12 38.12 G (mm) 587 587 740 740 740 740 968 968 968 968 740 740 740 740 740 740 740 740 968 968 968 968 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1307 Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Side-Mounted Panels Panels provide extra mounting space on the sides of enclosures. 12 gauge steel side-mounting panels are painted white. Conductive panels are steel with a conductive, corrosion-resistant coating. Panels attach securely to mounting channels. Plated steel mounting hardware is furnished. Bulletin: PNL30, PNLFS Catalog Number A60SMP14 Description Painted steel A60SMP14G Conductive A72SMP14 Painted steel A72SMP14G Conductive A72SMP20 Painted steel A72SMP20G Conductive A90SMP14 Painted steel A90SMP14G Conductive A90SMP20 Painted steel A90SMP20G Conductive Panel Size DxE in./mm 48.00 x 14.00 1219 x 356 48.00 x 14.00 1219 x 356 60.00 x 14.00 1524 x 356 60.00 x 14.00 1524 x 356 60.00 x 20.00 1524 x 508 60.00 x 20.00 1524 x 508 78.00 x 14.00 1981 x 356 78.00 x 14.00 1981 x 356 78.00 x 20.00 1981 x 508 78.00 x 20.00 1981 x 508 Fits Enclosure A in./mm 60.00 1524 60.00 1524 72.00 1829 72.00 1829 72.00 1829 72.00 1829 90.00 2286 90.00 2286 90.00 2286 90.00 2286 A90SMP14 and A90SMP14G will not fit 18.06-in.deep two-door enclosures (FSD style) if regular panel is also installed. A90SMP20 and A90SMP20G will not fit 20.12-in. deep enclosures. Will not fit 24.12-in. deep two-door enclosures (FSD style) if regular panel is also installed. Heavy Duty Panel Supports Heavy Duty Panel Supports, sold in pairs, are used in place of the panel supports furnished with panels when heavy equipment will be installed on the panels. They extend to the bottom of the enclosure. Adjustable mounting studs allow mounting of different height panels or a combination of panels. Use mounting hardware furnished with panels. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number A60FSHDPS A72FSHDPS A90FSHDPS Fits Enclosure A in./mm 60.00 1524 72.00 1829 90.00 2286 Support Length in./mm 57.25 1454 69.25 1759 87.25 2216 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1308 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Center Panel Supports Standard Product Panel Supports Catalog Number Fits Enclosure A (in.) Fits Enclosure A (mm) G (in.) Center panel supports are used with Free-Stand Type 12 (Bulletin A60FSCPS 60.00 1524 23.12 A30) two-door enclosures. They permit the installation of panels, A72FSCPS 72.00 1829 29.12 swing-out panels and rack-mounting angles sized for one-door A90FSCPS 90.00 2286 38.12 enclosures. The Center Panel Support can be positioned from front to back of the enclosure. Accessory Width with Center Panel Supports Bulletin: A80 Two Door Enclosure Width (in.) 48.00 60.00 72.00 Two Door Enclosure Width (mm) 1219 1524 1829 Accessory Width (in.) 24.00 30.00 36.00 G (mm) 587 740 968 Accessory Width (mm) 610 762 914 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1309 Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1310 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Enclosures Swing-Out Panels for Free-Stand Type 4, 4X and 12 Enclosures with Mounting Channel Panels for Free-Stand Type 12 Enclosures, Free-Stand Type 4 Enclosures and One-Door Type 4X Free-Stand Fiberglass Enclosures. Full-length and half-length swing-out panels are available. Half-length panels can be located in the upper or lower portion of the enclosures. Swing-out panels have a 10 gauge steel support frame and two heavy-gauge continuous hinges which permit the panel to swing completely out of the enclosure if it is located within approximately 10.75 in. (273 mm) of the door. These panels are 12 gauge steel and can be mounted on either side of the enclosure. Panels are finished with white polyester powder paint and furnished with plated mounting hardware. Bulletin: PNL30 Catalog Number A72SP24F3 A72SP24F4 A72SP30F3 A72SP30F4 A72SP36F3 A72SP36F4 A90SP36F3 A90SP36F4 Description Full Panel Half Panel Full Panel Half Panel Full Panel Half Panel Full Panel Half Panel Panel Size D x E (in.) 60.00 x 18.81 30.88 x 18.81 60.00 x 24.81 30.88 x 24.81 60.00 x 30.81 30.88 x 30.81 78.00 x 30.81 39.88 x 30.81 Panel Size D x E (mm) 1524 x 478 784 x 478 1524 x 630 784 x 630 1524 x 783 784 x 783 1981 x 783 1013 x 783 Fits Enclosure A x B (in.) 72.00 x 24.00 72.00 x 24.00 72.00 x 30.00 72.00 x 30.00 72.00 x 36.00 72.00 x 36.00 90.00 x 36.00 90.00 x 36.00 Fits Enclosure A x B (mm) 1829 x 610 1829 x 610 1829 x 762 1829 x 762 1829 x 914 1829 x 914 2286 x 914 2286 x 914 Q (in.) 21.84 21.84 27.84 27.84 33.84 33.84 33.84 33.84 Q (mm) 555 555 707 707 860 860 860 860 Panels for WiFi Cabinets and Small Wall-Mount Enclosures Panels are available in both steel and wood. Steel panels are 14 gauge steel with a white polyester powder paint finish. Wood panels are 3/4-in. plywood and are unfinished. Wood panels are supplied with Fiberglass Hinged-Cover and POLYPRO® Type 4X WiFi Cabinets. Bulletin: DWS12, PNLJ, PNLWM Catalog Number A6P6 A6P6WD A16P14 A16P14WD A18P16 A18P16WD Material Steel Wood Steel Wood Steel Wood Panel Size D x E (in.) 4.88 x 4.88 4.88 x 4.88 14.75 x 12.88 14.75 x 12.88 16.75 x 14.88 16.75 x 14.88 Subject to change without notice Panel Size D x E (mm) 124 x 124 124 x 124 375 x 327 375 x 327 425 x 378 425 x 378 V (in.) 0.31 0.31 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 V (mm) 8 8 6 6 6 6 PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1311 Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Open Frame Racks Panels for Open Frame Racks Rack Panel for 19-in. Racks Used to cover unused rack space in cabinets or open frame racks for a finished appearance. Can also be used for surface mounting small devices. Panels are flat with mounting slots spaced at 19-in. EIA standard spacing. Made of 12 gauge steel with RAL 9005 black polyester powder paint finish. Mounting hardware sold separately. Catalog Number P19RPP1UB P19RPP2UB P19RPP3UB P19RPP4UB P19RPP5UB P19RPP6UB Rack Units 1 2 3 4 5 6 E (in.) 1.75 3.50 5.25 7.00 8.75 10.50 E (mm) 44 89 133 178 222 267 Bulletin: DOFRY Tool-less (Snap-in) Blanking Panels for 19-in. Racks These Tool-less 19-in. Blanking Panels provide easy tool-less installation and ensure proper airflow to equipment. Made of black composite material and can be used with tapped or square EIA universal spaced rack mounting angles. Catalog Number D19BPT1RU Description Blanking Panel, 19 in. Rack Units 1 D19BPT2RU Blanking Panel, 19 in. 2 Fits 19 in., universal rack spacing, tapped or square holes 19 in., universal rack spacing, tapped or square holes Pkg. Qty. 10 10 Bulletin: DACCY CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1312 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panels for Open Frame Racks Rack Panels Rack Panels are available in aluminum and painted steel. Aluminum Rack Panels are .125-in.-thick 5052-H32 alloy. Steel Rack Panels are 12 gauge steel and finished in RAL 7035 textured light-gray polyester powder paint. All panels are flat with oblong holes positioned at EIA standard spacing. Mounting hardware is sold separately. Bulletin: P20 Catalog Number P19RP1UA P19RP1UP P19RP2UA P19RP2UP P19RP3UA P19RP3UP P19RP4UA P19RP4UP P19RP5UA P19RP5UP P19RP6UP P19RP6UA P19RP7UA P19RP7UP P19RP8UP P19RP8UA P19RP9UA P19RP9UP P19RP10UA P19RP10UP P19RP11UA P19RP11UP P19RP12UA P19RP12UP P19RP16UA P19RP16UP P23RP1UA P23RP1UP P23RP2UP P23RP3UA P23RP3UP P23RP4UA P23RP4UP P24RP2UA P24RP2UP P24RP3UP P24RP4UA P24RP4UP P24RP5UA P24RP5UP P24RP6UP P24RP8UA P24RP8UP Material Aluminum Steel Aluminum Steel Aluminum Steel Aluminum Steel Aluminum Steel Steel Aluminum Aluminum Steel Steel Aluminum Aluminum Steel Aluminum Steel Aluminum Steel Aluminum Steel Aluminum Steel Aluminum Steel Steel Aluminum Steel Aluminum Steel Aluminum Steel Steel Aluminum Steel Aluminum Steel Steel Aluminum Steel Rack Angle Size 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 23 in. 23 in. 23 in. 23 in. 23 in. 23 in. 23 in. 24 in. 24 in. 24 in. 24 in. 24 in. 24 in. 24 in. 24 in. 24 in. 24 in. Rack Units 1 1 2 2 3 3 4 4 5 5 6 6 7 7 8 8 9 9 10 10 11 11 12 12 16 16 1 1 2 3 3 4 4 2 2 3 4 4 5 5 6 8 8 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1313 Accessories: Panels and Panel Accessories Panel Accessories Panel Lifting Hooks Panel Accessories Used to lift a large interior panel to position it in an enclosure lying on its back and to transport a panel from one location to another. Comfortable hand grip. Plated finish. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number APLH Panel Support Kit Description Two lifting hooks with handles Provide additional support for panels on which heavy components are mounted. Each panel support fits over a collar stud and is then adjusted so the weight of the panel is partially supported by the bottom of the enclosure. Locknuts prevent accidental change in adjustment. A polyethylene-covered base on each panel support distributes the panel weight and prevents damage to the interior finish. Constructed of heavy-gauge steel. White finish. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number APS3 APS9 Description Two panel supports for 1-door or 2-door enclosures where distance from bottom of panel to bottom of enclosure is less than 2.25 inches (57mm). Two panel supports for free-standing or multi-door enclosures where distance from bottom of panel to bottom of enclosure is between 2.88 inches (73mm) and 8.50 inches (216mm). CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1314 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Window Kits Window Kits Window Kits Window Kits Steel and Stainless Steel Window Kits and 13 enclosures in indoor or outdoor applications where corrosion is a problem. These kits are easily installed by making a cutout in the enclosure and attaching the window and frame in place. Frames are made from heavy-gauge steel with an ANSI 61 gray polyester powder finish over pretreated surfaces or from heavy-gauge Type 304 stainless steel with a brushed finish. The window is .25-in. (6mm) acrylic for steel kits or .25-in. (6-mm) polycarbonate material for stainless steel kits. Oil-resistant gasketing ensures a water-tight seal around the perimeter of the window and frame. All mounting hardware is furnished. Custom sizes, materials and finishes can be provided on special order. Consult factory for information. Bulletin: A80SW, A80W Industry Standards UL 508A Component Recognized; Type 4, 4X (stainless steel version only), 12, 13; File No. E61997 CSA Type 4, 4X (stainless steel version only), 12,13; File No. 42186 NEMA/EEMAC 4, 4X (stainless steel version only), 12, 13 IEC 60529, IP66 Steel Window Kits are designed to be used on Type 4 and 12 enclosures. Stainless Steel Window Kits are suitable for Type 4, 4X, 12 Catalog Number APWK53NF APWK53NFSS APWK95NF APWK95NFSS APWK711NFSS APWK133NF APWK138NF APWK138NFSS APWK715NFSS APWK175NF APWK1711NF APWK1711NFSS APWK720NFSS APWK2315NF APWK2315NFSS APWK724NFSS APWK729NFSS APWK2919NF APWK2919NFSS APWK3523NF AxB in. 7.50 x 5.50 7.50 x 5.50 11.50 x 8.00 11.50 x 8.00 13.50 x 9.50 15.50 x 5.50 15.50 x 10.50 15.50 x 10.50 17.50 x 9.50 19.50 x 8.00 19.50 x 13.50 19.50 x 13.50 22.50 x 9.50 25.50 x 17.50 25.50 x 17.50 26.50 x 9.50 31.50 x 9.50 31.50 x 21.50 31.50 x 21.50 37.50 x 25.50 AxB mm 191 x 140 191 x 140 292 x 203 292 x 203 343 x 241 394 x 140 394 x 267 394 x 267 343 x 445 495 x 203 495 x 343 495 x 343 572 x 241 648 x 445 648 x 445 673 x 241 800 x 241 800 x 546 800 x 546 953 x 445 Material Steel Stainless Steel Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Steel Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Steel Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Steel Stainless Steel Steel Window Size M x N (in.) 5.00 x 3.00 5.00 x 3.00 9.00 x 5.50 9.00 x 5.50 11.00 x 7.00 13.00 x 3.00 13.00 x 8.00 13.00 x 8.00 15.00 x 7.00 17.00 x 5.50 17.00 x 11.00 17.00 x 11.00 20.00 x 7.00 23.00 x 15.00 23.00 x 15.00 24.00 x 7.00 29.00 x 7.00 29.00 x 19.00 29.00 x 19.00 35.00 x 23.00 Window Size M x N (mm) 127 x 76 127 x 76 229 x 140 229 x 140 279 x 178 330 x 76 330 x 203 330 x 203 381 x 178 432 x 140 432 x 279 432 x 279 508 x 178 584 x 381 584 x 381 610 x 178 737 x 178 737 x 483 737 x 483 889 x 584 Required Cutout Size G x H (in.) 6.69 x 4.69 6.69 x 4.69 10.69 x 7.19 10.69 x 7.19 12.69 x 8.69 14.69 x 4.69 14.69 x 9.69 14.69 x 9.69 16.69 x 8.69 18.69 x 7.19 18.69 x 12.69 18.69 x 12.69 21.69 x 8.69 24.69 x 16.69 24.69 x 16.69 25.69 x 8.69 30.69 x 8.69 30.69 x 20.69 30.69 x 20.69 36.69 x 24.69 Required Cutout Size G x H (mm) 170 x 119 170 x 119 272 x 183 272 x 183 392 x 211 373 x 119 373 x 246 373 x 246 424 x 211 475 x 183 475 x 322 475 x 322 551 x 221 627 x 424 627 x 424 653 x 221 780 x 221 780 x 526 780 x 526 932 x 627 When determining if a window kit will fit in a door or cover, be sure to allow for gaskets, data pockets, door handles, latch rods and other parts attached to the door or cover. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1315 Accessories: Window Kits Window Kits Frameless Window Kit Designed for use on many Type 12 and 13 enclosures. These kits are for indoor use in a temperature range of 55 F to 125 F (13 C to 52 C). For more severe conditions use Steel or Stainless Steel Window Kits. The window is scratch-resistant .12-in. (3-mm) polycarbonate. Special high-strength, double-sided tape is supplied as well as screw fasteners. Windows can be cut to smaller sizes. Allow .50-in. (13-mm) overlap on each side of window for tape. Bulletin: A80W Catalog Number APWKE52 APWKE96 APWKE133 Window Size in./mm 5.50 x 3.00 140 x 76 9.62 x 7.19 244 x 183 13.88 x 3.88 353 x 99 Maximum Cutout Size in./mm 4.50 x 2.00 114 x 51 8.62 x 6.19 219 x 157 12.88 x 2.88 327 x 73 Wing Knobs for CONCEPT® Window Kits Knobs are optional latching for hinged windows and hinged bezels. Knobs are black and available in locking and nonlocking versions. Keylocking knob maintains Type 12 rating only. Catalog Number CWKL CWKN Description Wing Knob, locking Wing Knob, nonlocking Bulletin: C2 CONCEPT® Fixed and Hinged Window Kits Aesthetic die-cast aluminum frame has .188-in. (5-mm) thick, clear polycarbonate window. Pre-assembled kit is secured to front opening of enclosure by four mounting screws. Furnished window frame caps conceal mounting screws. Hinged window kit is hinged on left side and has a single-point slotted latch (optional locking or non-locking wing knob latch is also available). Textured finish, ANSI 61 gray or RAL 7035 light gray. Bulletin: C2 Catalog Number CWF3136 CWF3136LG CWH3136 CWH3136LG CWF4045 CWF4045LG CWH4045 CWH4045LG CWF5557 CWF5557LG CWH5557 AxBxC in. 12.20 x 14.17 x 1.26 12.20 x 14.17 x 1.26 12.20 x 14.17 x 1.34 12.20 x 14.17 x 1.34 15.75 x 17.72 x 1.30 15.75 x 17.72 x 1.30 15.75 x 17.72 x 1.38 15.75 x 17.72 x 1.38 21.65 x 22.44 x 1.42 21.65 x 22.44 x 1.42 21.65 x 22.44 x 1.50 AxBxC mm 310 x 360 x 32 310 x 360 x 32 310 x 360 x 34 310 x 360 x 34 400 x 450 x 33 400 x 450 x 33 400 x 450 x 35 400 x 450 x 35 550 x 570 x 36 550 x 570 x 36 550 x 570 x 38 Finish ANSI 61 RAL 7035 ANSI 61 RAL 7035 ANSI 61 RAL 7035 ANSI 61 RAL 7035 ANSI 61 RAL 7035 ANSI 61 Description Fixed window kit Fixed window kit Hinged window kit Hinged window kit Fixed window kit Fixed window kit Hinged window kit Hinged window kit Fixed window kit Fixed window kit Hinged window kit Window Size M x N (mm) 253 x 276 253 x 276 253 x 276 253 x 276 343 x 366 343 x 366 343 x 366 343 x 366 493 x 486 493 x 486 493 x 486 Window Size M x N (in.) 9.96 x 10.86 9.96 x 10.86 9.96 x 10.86 9.96 x 10.86 13.50 x 14.40 13.50 x 14.40 13.50 x 14.40 13.50 x 14.40 19.40 x 19.13 19.40 x 19.13 19.40 x 19.13 CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1316 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Window Kits Window Kits CONCEPT® Deep Hinged Window Kit Kit is hinged on left side and has a single-point slotted latch (optional locking or non-locking wing knob latch is also available). Aesthetic die-cast aluminum frame has .188-in. (5-mm) thick, clear polycarbonate window. Two-inch space between enclosure front opening and window surface accommodates switches, lights, meters and other components. This kit can be used as an accessory window kit on larger standard Hoffman enclosure doors. Textured finish, ANSI 61 gray or RAL 7035 light gray. Bulletin: C2 Catalog Number CWHD3136 CWHD3136LG CWHD4045 CWHD4045LG CWHD5557 AxBxC in. 12.20 x 14.17 x 3.31 12.20 x 14.17 x 3.31 15.75 x 17.72 x 3.39 15.75 x 17.72 x 3.39 21.65 x 22.44 x 3.50 AxBxC mm 310 x 360 x 84 310 x 360 x 84 400 x 450 x 86 400 x 450 x 86 550 x 570 x 89 Finish ANSI 61 RAL 7035 ANSI 61 RAL 7035 ANSI 61 Window Size M x N (mm) 253 x 276 253 x 276 343 x 366 343 x 366 493 x 486 Window Size M x N (in.) 9.96 x 10.86 9.96 x 10.86 13.50 x 14.40 13.50 x 14.40 19.40 x 19.13 Type 12 Hinged Window Kit Industry Standards UL 508A Component Recognized; Type 12; File No. E61997 CSA Type 12; File No. 42186 NEMA/EEMAC Type 12 IEC 60529, IP55 For use as a viewing window where access to components mounted behind the window is required. Window is .25-in. (6-mm) clear acrylic. Easily mounted by drilling the appropriate mounting holes. All mounting hardware is provided. Continuous gaskets on all openings maintain UL Type 12 integrity. Finish is ANSI 61 gray polyester powder paint. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Bulletin: A80W Catalog Number APWK1212H APWK1612H APWK2016H APWK2020H APWK2420H APWK3024H Subject to change without notice Window Size M x N in./mm 10.28 x 10.28 261 x 261 14.28 x 10.28 363 x 261 18.28 x 14.28 464 x 363 18.28 x 18.28 464 x 464 22.28 x 18.28 566 x 464 28.28 x 22.28 718 x 566 Overall L x W in./mm 12.00 x 12.00 305 x 305 16.00 x 12.00 406 x 305 20.00 x 16.00 508 x 406 20.00 x 20.00 508 x 508 24.00 x 20.00 610 x 508 30.00 x 24.00 762 x 610 PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com S in./mm 10.44 265 10.44 265 14.44 367 18.44 468 18.44 468 22.44 570 T in./mm 10.44 265 14.44 367 18.44 468 18.44 468 22.44 570 28.44 722 © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1317 Accessories: Window Kits Window Kits Type 4 and 4X Deep-Hinged Window Kits Accessories Touch-up Paint (ATPPY61) Options Optional Handles CWHNL - Nonlocking CWHK - Keylocking CWHPTO - Padlocking Bulletin: A80SW, A80W Standard Product Catalog Number AWDH1418N4 AWDH1418N4SS AWDH1612N4 AWDH1612N4SS AWDH2016N4 Industry Standards AWDH2016N4SS Stainless Steel AWDH2416N4 UL 508A Listed; Type 3R, 4, 4X, 12; File No. E61997 cUL Listed per CSA C22.2, No. 94; Type 3R, 4, 4X, 12; File No. E61997 AWDH2416N4SS AWDH2420N4 NEMA/EEMAC Type 3R, 4, 4X, 12 IEC 60529, IP66 AWDH2420N4SS Mild Steel AWDH2430N4 UL 508A Listed; Type 4, 12; File No. E61997 cUL Listed per CSA C22.2 No. 94; Type 4, 12; File No. E61997 NEMA/EEMAC Type 4, 12 AWDH2430N4SS AWDH3024N4 Application AWDH3024N4SS Deep-hinged window kits provide protection, visibility and easy access to equipment and components installed behind the viewing area. Window kits are conveniently sized to allow direct mounting in the usable door area of Hoffman NEMA and CONCEPT® wall-mount enclosures, as well as any Hoffman enclosure with a suitably sized mounting surface. Deep-hinged window kits provide protection, visibility and easy access to equipment and components installed behind the viewing area. These kits have an aesthetic appearance, quarter-turn latching for easy access, .25-in. (6-mm) thick, clear polycarbonate material for viewing, 2.5-in. (64-mm) depth to allow for deep controls and a built-in gasket compression stop to facilitate flush mounting. Each kit comes with a mounting template and hardware to allow for easy installation and can be mounted either left or right hinged. AWDH3624N4 AWDH3624N4SS AxBxC in./mm 12.19 x 14.56 x 2.73 310 x 370 x 69 12.19 x 14.56 x 2.73 310 x 370 x 69 14.19 x 8.14 x 2.73 360 x 207 x 69 14.19 x 8.14 x 2.73 360 x 207 x 69 18.19 x 12.14 x 2.73 462 x 308 x 69 18.19 x 12.14 x 2.73 462 x 308 x 69 22.19 x 12.14 x 2.73 563 x 308 x 69 22.19 x 12.14 x 2.73 563 x 308 x 69 22.19 x 16.14 x 2.73 563 x 410 x 69 22.19 x 16.14 x 2.73 563 x 410 x 69 22.19 x 26.14 x 2.73 563 x 664 x 69 22.19 x 26.14 x 2.73 563 x 664 x 69 28.19 x 20.14 x 2.73 716 x 512 x 69 28.19 x 20.14 x 2.73 716 x 512 x 69 34.19 x 20.14 x 2.73 868 x 512 x 69 34.19 x 20.14 x 2.73 868 x 512 x 69 B 316L Stainless steel Steel 316L Stainless steel Steel 316L Stainless steel Steel 316L Stainless steel Steel 316L Stainless steel Steel 316L Stainless steel Steel 316L Stainless steel Steel 316L Stainless steel C N Specifications •• M anufactured from Type 316L stainless steel or painted mild steel •• Quarter-turn latches for quick access •• 0.25-in. (6-mm) thick, clear polycarbonate windows for easy viewing •• 2.5-in. (64-mm) deep to allow for deep controls •• Built-in gasket compression stop on back of window kit facilitates flush mounting •• Designed for either left or right hinging •• Includes mounting template and mounting hardware •• Easy-to-remove clip-style hinge pin A M 87948405 Finish •• S tainless steel: Enclosures are unpainted; door and body have a smooth #4 brushed finish •• Mild steel: ANSI 61 gray polyester powder paint inside and out 1318 Material Steel Window Size MxN in./mm 8.93 x 9.86 227 x 250 8.93 x 9.86 227 x 250 10.91 x 3.39 277 x 66 10.91 x 3.39 277 x 66 15.60 x 8.08 396 x 205 15.60 x 8.08 396 x 205 19.60 x 8.08 498 x 205 19.60 x 8.08 498 x 205 19.60 x 12.08 498 x 307 19.60 x 12.08 498 x 307 19.60 x 20.89 498 x 531 19.60 x 20.89 498 x 531 25.60 x 14.89 650 x 378 25.60 x 14.89 650 x 378 31.60 x 14.89 803 x 378 31.60 x 14.89 803 x 378 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Window Kits Window Kits Notes CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1319 Accessories: Door Accessories Door Stops Door Stop Kit Door Accessories Door Stops Designed for use on most standard Hoffman Type 4 and 12 enclosures to secure the door in the open position. Enclosures must have a “B” dimension of 16.00 in. (406 mm) or more and a door which opens horizontally. Door Stop Kit can be mounted at the top or bottom of the door opening after drilling two small holes in the body of the enclosure and two small holes in the door. The angle of the door is easily adjusted by means of a wingnut, and the stop arm slides neatly out of the way when the door is closed. All parts are plated. Maintains UL/CSA Type 4 and Type 12 if properly installed in a Hoffman enclosure. Door Stop Kit is not intended for use on CONCEPT® window door enclosures, or enclosures configured with a swing-out panel or swing-out rack frame. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number ADSTOPK Type 316 Stainless Steel Door Stop Kit Description Door Stop Kit Application Type 316 stainless steel door stop kit is available for use in applications that require the kind of corrosion protection that only Type 316 stainless steel can provide. Typical applications include water treatment, pulp, paper, petroleum, chemical, food and pharmaceutical processing, and packaging. Kit includes all mounting hardware. Secures doors in the open position. Can be mounted at either top or bottom of door. Can be installed on either left- or righthinged doors. Maintains an enclosure’s Type 4X rating. Easy to install. Mounting hardware is Type 316 stainless steel. This door stop kit can only be mounted in wall-mount enclosures. Features •• •• •• •• an be mounted at either top or bottom of door C Can be installed on either left- or right-hinged doors Maintains an enclosure’s Type 4X rating Easy to install Specifications •• K it, including mounting hardware, constructed of Type 316 stainless steel Bulletin: A4SY Catalog Number ADSTOPKSS6 Large Enclosure Door Stop Kit Description Type 316 stainless steel door stop kit Designed for use with most standard, large mild and stainless steel enclosures to secure the door in the 90 degree open position. Door Stop Kit can be mounted at the top or bottom of the door opening after drilling two small holes in the door and enclosure. All parts are plated. Maintains UL/CSA Type 4 and Type 12 if properly installed in a Hoffman enclosure. Bulletin: A34Y Catalog Number ALGDSTOP2 Description Large Enclosure Door Stop Kit CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1320 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Door Accessories Data Pockets Thermoplastic Data Pocket Data Pockets Provides a convenient place to store wiring diagrams, operation manuals and other documentation inside the enclosure. Adhesivebacked pockets mount inside the solid enclosure cover. Mounting hardware included. Thermoplastic pockets are dark gray and have cut-away areas for easy inspection of contents. Catalog Number ADP1 Description Small pocket ADP2 Large pocket Bulletin: UX1Y Size L x W in./mm 6.00 x 6.00 152 x 152 12.00 x 12.00 305 x 305 Metal Data Pocket Three-inch (76-mm) deep Metal Data Pocket provides a convenient place to store wiring diagrams, operation manuals and other documentation inside the enclosure. Large enough to store 3-ring binders. Mounting hardware is included. Painted white and has cutaway areas for easy inspection of contents. Catalog Number ADP3 Bulletin: A34Y Fits A x B in./mm greater than or equal to 30.00 x 24.00 greater than or equal to 762 x 610 Size L x W in./mm 12.00 x 12.00 305 x 305 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1321 Accessories: Door Accessories Data Pockets External Data Pockets, Type 4/4X/12 Industry Standards Features Mild Steel Models: •• A vailable in mild steel or stainless steel to match the enclosure finish •• Foam-in-place gasket to protect documentation from harsh environments •• Hinged front for easy access to contents •• Three sizes accommodate a wide variety of documents •• Sloped top sheds liquids and prevents accumulation of extraneous material •• Optional wing knob and keylock inserts available for additional security UL 508A Listed; Type 4, 12; File No. E61997 cUL Listed per C22.2 No. 94; Type 4, 12; File No. E61997 NEMA/EEMAC Type 4, 12 IEC 60529, IP66 Stainless Steel Models: UL 508A Listed; Type 4, 4X, 12; File No. E61997 cUL Listed per C22.2 No. 94; Type 4, 4X, 12; File No. E61997 Specifications NEMA/EEMAC Type 4, 4X, 12 IEC 60529, IP66 •• 1 6 gauge steel or 16 gauge Type 304 stainless steel •• Front of pocket hinges away from frame Application Mounted on the exterior of an enclosure, Data Pockets allow access to system documentation without having to open the enclosure door. Finish Mild steel models are either ANSI 61 medium-gray or RAL 7035 lightgray polyester powder finish inside and out. Stainless steel models have brushed finish. Accessories Key Inserts Wing Knob Latch Bulletin: A70E Standard Product Catalog Number ADPX4A ADPX4ALG ADPX4ASS ADPX4B ADPX4BLG ADPX4BSS ADPX4C ADPX4CLG ADPX4CSS AxBxC in. 15.10 x 12.25 x 3.18 15.10 x 12.25 x 3.18 15.10 x 12.25 x 3.18 6.83 x 6.25 x 2.18 6.83 x 6.25 x 2.18 6.83 x 6.25 x 2.18 12.96 x 18.25 x 2.68 12.96 x 18.25 x 2.68 12.96 x 18.25 x 2.68 AxBxC mm 384 x 311 x 81 384 x 311 x 81 384 x 311 x 81 173 x 159 x 55 173 x 159 x 55 173 x 159 x 55 329 x 484 x 68 329 x 484 x 68 329 x 484 x 68 Finish ANSI 61 paint RAL 7035 paint Brushed stainless steel ANSI 61 paint RAL 7035 paint Brushed stainless steel ANSI 61 paint RAL 7035 paint Brushed stainless steel G (in.) 12.00 12.00 12.00 4.00 4.00 4.00 10.00 10.00 10.00 G (mm) 305 305 305 102 102 102 254 254 254 H (in.) 10.00 10.00 10.00 4.00 4.00 4.00 16.00 16.00 16.00 H (mm) 254 254 254 102 102 102 406 406 406 J (in.) 14.25 14.25 14.25 6.25 6.25 6.25 12.25 12.25 12.25 J (mm) 362 362 362 159 159 159 311 311 311 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1322 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Door Accessories Data Pockets CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1323 Accessories: Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates Folding Shelves Stainless Steel Folding Shelf Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates Folding Shelves Catalog Number ACSHELF1212SS ACSHELF1818SS ACSHELF2424SS Size AxB in./mm 12.00 x 12.00 305 x 305 18.00 x 18.00 457 x 457 24.00 x 24.00 610 x 610 Maximum Distributed Load Rating (lb.) 150 Maximum Distributed Load Rating (kg) 68 150 68 150 68 Supports instruments and test equipment used to install and maintain electrical components in an enclosure. Also ideally suited for supporting laptop computers, monitoring units and other equipment used with programmable controllers. The shelf can be installed on the inside or outside surface of larger Hoffman industrial enclosures (except PROLINE®). Automatically locks in the horizontal position when raised. When not in use, the shelf folds down and projects only 1 in. (25 mm) from the mounting surface. Constructed of 304 stainless steel with a brushed finish. Maintains UL/CSA Type 4, 4X and 12 rating when properly installed on a Hoffman enclosure. Bulletin: A80 Large Folding Shelf Catalog Number AASHLF1218 AASHLF1818 AASHLF2424 Size AxB in./mm 18.00 x 12.00 457 x 305 18.00 x 18.00 457 x 457 24.00 x 24.00 610 x 610 Maximum Distributed Load Rating (lb.) 150 Maximum Distributed Load Rating (kg) 68 Finish White 150 68 White 150 68 White Catalog numbers ACSHELF12 and ACSHELF18 have been obsoleted. Please use the shelves above as replacements. Supports instruments and test equipment used to install and maintain electrical components in an enclosure. Also ideally suited for supporting laptop computers, monitoring units and other equipment used with programmable controllers. The shelf can be installed on the inside or outside surface of larger Hoffman industrial enclosures (except PROLINE®). Automatically locks in the horizontal position when raised. When not in use, the shelf folds to 1.73 in. (44 mm) from the mounting surface. All parts are heavy gauge steel and painted white. Maintains UL/CSA Type 4 and 12 when properly intalled on a Hoffman enclosure. Bulletin: A34Y, A80 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1324 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates Shelves for Open Frame Racks Double-Sided Solid Aluminum Shelf Shelves for Open Frame Racks Mounts on 19-in. open frame rack. Two shelves form double-sided shelf. Uses 4U rack space. Made of 0.090-in. thick aluminum with brushed finish. Maximum load rating: 100 lb. (45.4 kg) per side, 200 lb. (90.7 kg) total Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number ESHDA19 HxWxD in./mm 5.62 x 19.31 x 9.37 143 x 490 x 238 Fits Rack 19 in. Includes 2 shelves Rack Units 4 Double-Sided, Solid Aluminum, Heavy Duty Shelf Mounts on open frame rack. Two shelves form double-sided shelf. Uses 4U rack space. Made of 0.090-in. thick aluminum with brushed finish. Maximum Load Rating: 150 lb. (68.0 kg) per side, 300 lb. (136.1 kg) total Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number ESHDHDA19 HxWxD in./mm 6.37 x 19.31 x 10.00 162 x 490 x 254 Fits Rack 19 in. Includes 2 shelves Rack Units 4 Single-Sided Solid Aluminum Shelf Mounts in a cabinet or on a 19-in. open-frame rack and can be wall mounted. Made of 0.090-in. thick aluminum with brushed finish. Maximum load rating: 100 lb. (45.4 kg) Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number ESHA19 HxWxD in./mm 5.25 x 18.31 x 15.00 133 x 465 x 381 Fits Rack 19 in. Rack Units 3 Single-Sided Solid-Steel Shelf Solid shelf mounts to either front or rear flange of open-frame rack. Uses 3U of rack space. Steel with textured black finish. Load rating: 150 lb. (68.0 kg) Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number ESH19S ESH23S HxWxD in./mm 4.85 x 19.00 x 10.50 123 x 483 x 267 4.85 x 23.00 x 10.50 123 x 584 x 267 Fits Rack 19 in. Rack Units 3 23 in. 3 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1325 Accessories: Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates Shelves for Open Frame Racks Single-Sided Steel Vented Shelf Vented shelf mounts to either front or rear flange of open-frame rack. Steel with textured black polyester powder paint finish. Load rating: 150 lb. (68.0 kg) Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number ESH19V ESH23V HxWxD in./mm 4.85 x 19.00 x 10.50 123 x 483 x 267 4.85 x 23.00 x 10.50 123 x 584 x 267 Fits Rack 19 in. Rack Units 3 23 in. 3 Double-Sided Solid-Steel Shelf Solid double-deep shelf mounts to both front and rear flanges of open frame rack. Steel with textured black polyester powder paint finish. Load rating: 300 lb. (136.1 kg) Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number ESHD19 ESHD23 HxWxD in./mm 4.85x 19.00 x 10.50 123 x 483 x 267 4.85 x 23.00 x 10.50 123 x 584 x 267 Fits Rack 19 in. Rack Units 3 23 in. 3 Double-Sided Steel Vented Shelf Vented, double-deep shelf mounts to both front and rear flanges of open frame rack. Steel with textured black polyester powder paint finish. Load rating: 300 lb. (136.1 kg) Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number ESHDV19 ESHDV23 HxWxD in./mm 4.85 x 19.00 x 10.50 123 x 483 x 267 4.85 x 23.00 x 10.50 123 x 584 x 267 Fits Rack 19 in. Rack Units 3 23 in. 3 Center-Mount Steel Shelves 19-in. shelf mounts to the front of the rack. Ideal for supporting monitors or computers. Designed to evenly distribute load across the rack. Manufactured from 16 gauge steel. Black, low-gloss, lighttextured polyester powder paint finish on all surfaces. Load rating: 100 lb. (45.4 kg) Bulletin: DOFRC Catalog Number ECMS1918 ECMS1922 ECMSV1918 ECMSV1922 HxWxD in./mm 3.50 x 19.00 x 18.00 89 x 483 x 457 3.50 x 19.00 x 22.00 89 x 483 x 559 3.50 x 19.00 x 18.00 89 x 483 x 457 3.50 x 19.00 x 22.00 89 x 483 x 559 Style Solid Rack Units 2 Solid 2 Vented 2 Vented 2 CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1326 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates Shelves for Open Frame Racks Rack-Mount Steel Shelf 19-in. Rack-Mount Shelf mounts to the front of the rack. Ideal for holding non-19-in. rack-mount equipment. Available with or without vents. Manufactured from 16 gauge steel. Black, low-gloss, lightly textured finish on all surfaces. Load rating: 100 lb. (45.4 kg) Bulletin: DOFRC Catalog Number EMS1918 EMS1922 EMSV1918 EMSV1922 HxWxD in./mm 5.25 x 19.00 x 18.00 133 x 483 x 457 5.25 x 19.00 x 22.00 133 x 483 x 559 5.25 x 19.00 x 18.00 133 x 483 x 457 5.25 x 19.00 x 22.00 133 x 483 x 559 Style Solid Rack Units 3 Solid 3 Vented 3 Vented 3 Adjustable Steel Vented Shelf Vented shelf adjustable front to back in 25-mm increments. Shelf mounts to either front or rear flange of open frame rack. Steel with textured black polyester powder paint finish. Load rating: 60 lb. (27.2 kg) Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number ESHVA19 ESHVA23 HxWxD in./mm 3.50 x 16.93 x 15.75 89 x 430 x 400 3.50 x 19.93 x 15.75 89 x 506 x 400 Fits Rack 19 in. Rack Units 2 23 in. 2 Pullout Keyboard Tray with Monitor Shelf Mounts to the front and back surfaces of a standard 3-in. open frame rack. Fits full-size keyboard. Includes mouse tray. Extends 10.5 in. (267 mm) beyond front of open frame rack. Keyboard tray slides out an additional 7 in. (178 mm). Uses 4U rack space. 16 gauge steel with RAL 9005 black polyester powder paint finish. Monitor shelf load rating: 100 lb. (45.4 kg) Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number E19SKBM HxWxD in./mm 7.00 x 19.90 x 10.24 178 x 505 x 260 Fits Rack 19 in. Rack Units 4 Pull-Out Shelf for Mini Keyboard Pull-Out Shelf for Mini Keyboard mounts either in a cabinet or on a 19-in. open-frame rack and fits a 16.25-in. (413-mm) wide keyboard. When closed, all parts slide between rack angles. Keyboard tray slides out 8.94 in. (227 mm). 16 gauge steel with RAL 9005 black polyester powder paint finish. Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number P19KBSM HxWxD in./mm 3.50 x 18.31 x 12.42 89 x 465 x 315 Fits Rack 19 in. Rack Units 2 CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1327 Accessories: Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates Shelves for Racks and Cabinets Pivoting Keyboard Shelf with Mouse Tray Shelves for Racks and Cabinets Mounts either in a cabinet or on a 19-in. open-frame rack. Shelf pulls out and pivots 90 degrees to access full-size keyboard. Shelf allows keyboard to slide between standard rack angles and includes mouse tray. 16 gauge steel with RAL 9005 black polyester powder paint finish. Keyboard tray extends 9.75 in. (248 mm) beyond front of rack angles or open-frame rack. Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number P19KBPVT HxWxD in./mm 3.50 x 18.89 x 19.25 89 x 480 x 489 Fits Rack 19 in. Rack Units 2 Steel Keyboard/Monitor Shelf Designed to accommodate a monitor and keyboard in an ergonomically engineered design. Shelf mounts to front flange of open-frame rack. Can mount in a cabinet if rack angles are adjusted back for door clearance. Uses 3U of rack space. 19-in. and 23-in. rack versions. Steel with textured black finish. Load rating: 200 lb. (91 kg) Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number ESH19KBM ESH23KBM HxWxD in./mm 5.25 x 17.38 x 15.10 133 x 441 x 384 5.25 x 21.38 x 15.10 133 x 543 x 384 Fits Rack 19 Rack Units 3 23 3 Pull-Out Shelf for Mini Keyboard Pull-Out Shelf for Mini Keyboard mounts either in a cabinet or on a 19-in. open-frame rack and fits a 16.25-in. (413-mm) wide keyboard. When closed, all parts slide between rack angles. Keyboard tray slides out 8.94 in. (227 mm). 16 gauge steel with RAL 9005 black polyester powder paint finish. Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number P19KBSM HxWxD in./mm 3.50 x 18.31 x 12.42 89 x 465 x 315 Fits Rack 19 in. Rack Units 2 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1328 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates Shelves for Racks and Cabinets Tool-less Shelf Catalog Number D19FVT69B Description Shelf, vented, 19 in. tool-less Finish Black D19FVT69G Shelf, vented, 19 in. tool-less Gray D19FVT912B Shelf, vented, 19 in. tool-less Black D19FVT912G Shelf, vented, 19 in. tool-less Gray Minimum Depth mm/in. 495 19.50 495 19.50 792 31.20 792 31.20 Maximum Depth mm/in. 851 33.50 851 33.50 1151 45.30 1151 45.30 Minimum and maximum depth measured from rack angle to rack angle. An easy-to-install tool-less vented 19-in. shelf. Mounts onto rack angles that have EIA-spaced square holes (.375 in.). Shelf slides open and provides a variable-sized, continuous surface for equipment. Back of shelf has oval cutouts for power and data cables. Accessory hole patterns at back of shelf fit small and large D-rings to help manage cable. Made of steel with a 150 lb. (68 kg) static load rating. Available with RAL 9005 black or RAL 7035 gray polyester powder coat finish. Bulletin: DACCY Rack-Mount Adjustable Shelf Mounts to front surface of front and back rack angles. Shelf is made of painted 14 gauge steel and the adjustable support brackets are clearplated 12 gauge steel. Adjustable to fit multiple-depth enclosures or rack angle placement. Both solid and vented models available. Fits 19- or 23-in. rack spacing. Requires only 1U of rack space. Shelf has RAL 7035 light-gray textured or RAL 9005 black textured polyester powder paint finish. Load rating: 150 lb. (68 kg) Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number P19SH68 P19SH68B P19VSH68B P19SH810 P19SH810B P19VSH810B P23SH68B P23VSH68B P23SH810B P23VSH810B Type Solid Solid Vented Solid Solid Vented Solid Vented Solid Vented Size 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 23 in. 23 in. 23 in. 23 in. Finish Gray Black Black Gray Black Black Black Black Black Black L x W (in.) 19.68 x 17.32 19.68 x 17.32 19.68 x 17.32 27.56 x 17.32 27.56 x 17.32 27.56 x 17.32 19.68 x 21.32 19.68 x 21.32 27.56 x 21.32 27.56 x 21.32 L x W (mm) 500 x 440 500 x 440 500 x 440 700 x 440 700 x 440 700 x 440 500 x 542 500 x 542 700 x 542 700 x 542 D max. (in.) 30.71 30.71 30.71 38.58 38.58 38.58 30.71 30.71 38.58 38.58 D max. (mm) 780 780 780 980 980 980 780 780 980 980 Fits Enclosure Depth Up To (in.) 31.50 31.50 31.50 39.37 39.37 39.37 31.50 31.50 39.37 39.37 Fits Enclosure Depth Up To (mm) 800 800 800 1000 1000 1000 800 800 1000 1000 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1329 Accessories: Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates Shelves for Racks and Cabinets Single-Sided Shelf Mounts to 19-in. rack angles to house voice/data networking equipment. RAL 9005 black finish. Load rating: 75 lb. (34 kg) Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number ESH198 ESH1915 ESH1915V ESH1917 H x W x D (in.) 3.74 x 19.00 x 8.00 3.74 x 19.00 x 15.00 3.74 x 19.00 x 15.00 3.74 x 19.00 x 17.00 H x W x D (mm) 95 x 483 x 203 95 x 483 x 381 95 x 483 x 381 95 x 483 x 432 Style Solid Solid Vented Solid Rack Units 2 2 2 2 Sliding Equipment Shelf Steel Sliding Equipment Shelf mounts to front surface of front and back rack angles. Models fit 19- or 23-in. rack spacing. Adjusts to fit multiple-depth enclosures and rack angle placements. Shelf can be used on 2-post rack or cabinet with front rack angles only by reversing support bracket. Optional cable manager arm available. 14 gauge steel with 12 gauge supports with RAL 9005 black polyester powder paint finish. Load rating: 150 lb. (68.0 kg) with four corner mounting; 75 lb. (34.0 kg) with two-post or front-rack-angle cabinet mounting. Optional Cable Manager Arm is recommended to help control cable movement as shelf slides in and out. Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number P19SHP68B P19SHP810B P23SHP68B P23SHP810B D (in.) 37.40 41.30 37.40 41.30 D (mm) 950 1050 950 1050 L (in.) 16.72 24.59 16.72 24.59 L (mm) 425 625 425 625 J (in.) 16.20 16.20 20.20 20.20 J (mm) 412 412 513 513 Shelf Pullout (in.) 17.00 19.00 17.00 19.00 Shelf Pullout (mm) 432 483 432 483 Fits Rack 19 in. 19 in. 23 in. 23 in. Rack Units 2 2 2 2 Cable Manager Arm for Sliding Equipment Shelf Cable Manager Arm mounts to back of sliding equipment shelf on right or left side. Controls cable movement as shelf slides in and out. 14 gauge steel with RAL 9005 black polyester powder paint finish. Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number PHCB Description Cable Manager Arm Use With Sliding Equipment Shelf CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1330 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates Shelves for Racks and Cabinets Keyboard Compartment for 19-in. Racks Provides a convenient way to incorporate a keyboard with other 19-in. rack-mounted equipment. Uses 2 RU of space. Made of light-weight aluminum with brushed finish. Accommodates keyboard up to 16.50-in. (419-mm) wide. Mounting hardware included. Fits rack width 19 Catalog Number A19KBC2B Rack Units 2 Bulletin: DACCY Rack-Angle Mounted Drawer Catalog Number P19DR1US P19DR2US P19DR3US H (mm) 43 88 132 H (in.) 1.69 3.47 5.20 Catalog Number P19WS Description Steel writing surface and cover Fits Rack Width 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. Rack Units 1 2 3 Steel drawer for 19-in. rack-angle mounting mounts to the front surface of the rack angles. Integral steel box contains the drawer and protects surrounding internal equipment. Extends 13 in. (330 mm) on ball bearing slides. Front includes handle and key lock. Finish is RAL 7035 textured light-gray polyester powder paint. Mounting hardware is included. Bulletin: P20 Writing Surface for Rack-Angle-Mounted Drawer Steel cover mounts on top of the drawer and serves as a writing surface and drawer cover. Finish is RAL 7035 light-gray textured polyester powder paint. Illustration and one photo show writing surface mounted on drawer. Order drawer separately. Fits Drawer (order separately) Bulletin: P20 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1331 Accessories: Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates Shelves for Racks and Cabinets 19-in. Fixed Shelf 14 gauge steel fixed shelf has large ventilation slots in shelf surface. Mounts between two pair of rack mounting angles that have accessory mounting legs. Shelves have RAL 7035 light-gray polyester powder paint finish. Plated mounting hardware is furnished. Bulletin: P20 Catalog Number A19SH5 A19SH6 A19SH8 D (in.) 16.06 20.00 27.87 D (mm) 408 508 708 E (in.) 10.46 14.40 22.27 E (mm) 266 366 566 F (in.) 13.46 17.40 25.27 F (mm) 342 442 642 Fits Rack Width 19 (in.) 19 (in.) 19 (in.) Pull-Out Shelves Pull-Out Shelves extend 17 in. (432 mm) on ball-bearing slides. 16 gauge pull-out shelf mounts to uprights in 19-in. electronic rack or 19-in. mini-rack using pull-out shelf bracket (EPSBKT) and has light-gray powder paint finish. Two screws captivate shelf to slides. 14 gauge steel pull-out shelf mounts between two pair of rackmounting angles that have accessory mounting legs and has white finish. Plated mounting hardware is furnished. Bulletin: DEC1, P20 Catalog Number A19SHP6 DL29SHP EPSBKT Fixed Shelf Description Pull-out shelf Pull-out shelf Pull-out shelf bracket Fits 19-in. rack angles 24-in. rack 14 gauge steel fixed shelf has a large slot in rear of shelf surface for wire management. Mounts between two pair of rack mounting angles that have accessory mounting legs. Shelves are white. Plated mounting hardware is furnished. Catalog Number DL29SH Fits Rack Width 24 (in.) Bulletin: P20 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1332 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates Drawers Drawers Drawers 16 gauge steel drawer extends 17.00 in. (432 mm) on ball bearing slides. Drawer has polyester powder paint finish and recessed black pull handle. Drawers mount between two pair of rack-mounting angles that have accessory mounting legs. Includes provision for attaching a writing surface. Plated steel mounting hardware is furnished. Bulletin: P20, X20 Catalog Number A19DR2U A19DR4U H in./mm 3.47 88 6.97 177 Color RAL 7035 Light Gray Fits Rack Width 19 in. RAL 7035 Light Gray 19 in. Enclosure must be at least 24-in. (600-mm) deep. CONCEPT® Keyboard Box Keyboard box is designed to fit on an outside surface of an enclosure to provide a self-contained external Type 4 housing for a keyboard. The box attaches to the enclosure surface with 4 bolts. A large hole and rubber plug are provided for keyboard cord and plug. The hinged cover is supported with flexible cables in the open position. A left and a right mouse tray slides out from under the keyboard mounting surface. VELCRO® strips with pressure-sensitive adhesive are supplied to attach a keyboard. An internal mouse storage pracket is provided. The box and cover are 16 gauge steel with ANSI 61 gray polyester powder paint finish. Cover latches with a single quarterturn slotted latch. Optional CONCEPT latches also fit. VELCRO is a trademark of Velcro Industries B.V. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number CKBC24 AxBxC in./mm 10.00 x 23.30 x 4.79 254 x 592 x 122 Max. Keyboard Size WxDxH in./mm 20.20 x 8.00 x 2.34 513 x 203 x 59 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1333 Accessories: Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates Gland Plates 16 Gauge Gland Plate Gland Plates K in./mm 9.00 229 17.00 432 Catalog Number DLGP610 DLGP618 L in./mm 9.94 252 17.94 457 Constructed of 16 gauge steel. Gland plates will maintain UL/CSA Type 12 integrity while providing a removable cable egress and entry plate. Easily installed by cutting a rectangular opening in the enclosure. Finish is ANSI 61 gray polyester powder paint. Bulletin: A80 12 Gauge Gland Plate Constructed of 12 gauge steel and designed for use with 10 gauge and 12 gauge enclosures. Provides a removable cable egress and entry plate while maintaining UL/NEMA integrity of the enclosure. Gasket with pressure-sensitive adhesive is included to be applied after desired modifications are completed. Finish is ANSI 61 gray polyester powder paint. Maintains UL/NEMA Type 4 and Type 12 if properly installed in a Hoffman enclosure. Bulletin: A34Y Catalog Number AGP618 AGP1218 AGP1618 Size in./mm 6.50 x 18.50 165 x 470 12.50 x 18.50 318 x 470 16.50 x 18.50 419 x 470 Opening Size in./mm 4.00 x 16.00 102 x 406 10.00 x 16.00 254 x 406 14.00 x 16.00 356 x 406 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1334 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates Gland Plates Notes CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1335 Accessories: Locks, Lockouts, Latches, Handles and Clamps Locks Lock Kit for Clamp Cover Junction Boxes Locks, Lockouts, Latches, Handles and Clamps Locks Catalog Number ACLJIC L (in.) 1.25 Catalog Number ACLSN12 L, for NEMA 12 Enclosure in./mm 1.69 43 L (mm) 32 Designed for field installation in standard clamp-cover junction boxes. Includes complete installation instructions. One hole must be drilled or punched in the cover to receive the cylinder lock. Punches for Hoffman locks and latches are available from Greenlee Punches. For more information on Greenlee punches, go to http://www. greenlee.textron.com/ Bulletin: A80 Lock Kit for Type 3R and 12 Enclosures L, for Medium 3R Hinged-Cover Enclosure in./mm 2.25 57 Designed for field installation in standard one-door Type 3R and 12 enclosures. Includes complete installation instructions. One hole must be drilled or punched in the door to receive the cylinder lock. Bulletin: A80 Padlock Kit for Junction Boxes Designed for field installation on standard LP, CH and CHNF junction boxes. Maintains water-tight and dust-tight seal. To install simply drill two holes in the cover and two holes in the body. Includes complete instructions. Padlock Kit is plated steel or Type 316 stainless steel. Catalog Number APLKJIC APLKJIC6SS Description Plated steel Type 316 stainless steel Bulletin: A80 Replacement Keys Fits PROLINE® Network Cabinet and Networking Wall-Mount Cabinet. Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number E2233KEY E333KEY Key Code 2233 333 Includes 2 Keys 2 Keys Use with PROLINE®, Net Series, D-BOX™ , PC Cabinet, SOHO ACCESSPLUS® II, L-BOX® CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1336 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Locks, Lockouts, Latches, Handles and Clamps Lockouts Lockouts Safety Lockouts Provide a means of using multiple padlocks on a secured power source. Catalog number ASL6C includes a 10.00-in. (254-mm) plated steel chain. Manufactured from 10 gauge steel with six station holes. Red finish. Overall length is 5.06 in. (128 mm) and padlock holes are .38-in. (10-mm) in diameter. Catalog Number ASL6 ASL6C Description Without chain With chain Catalog Number ASLDA ASLDAC Description Without chain With chain Bulletin: A80 Dual-Access Safety Lockouts Provide a means of using two padlocks on a secured power source. Either padlock can be removed enabling power to be interrupted and enclosure accessed. Catalog number ASLDAC includes a 10.00in. (254-mm) plated steel chain. Lockouts are manufactured from 10 gauge steel and finished in red. Padlock holes are .38-in. (10-mm) in diameter. Padlock is not included. Bulletin: A80 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1337 Accessories: Locks, Lockouts, Latches, Handles and Clamps Latches Latches T-Handle Latch and Keyed Cylinder Lock Kits To install, simply remove the standard slotted latch and insert the kit. Complete installation instructions are furnished. Catalog number AL7A includes a Type L7 T handle and all hardware. Catalog number AL12AR includes a Type L12 cylinder lock, cam and all hardware. Latch and lock fit Type 1 enclosures and hingedcover pull boxes. Catalog Number AL7A AL12AR Description T handle latch kit Cylinder lock kit Bulletin: A80 Latch Kit for One-Door Type 12 Enclosures Designed for field installation on most standard one-door Type 12 enclosures. These latch kits will not fit Hoffman disconnect, CONCEPT® or PROLINE® enclosures. Each kit includes a handle, latch, latch rods, adjustable rod guides and all hardware. The latch rods can be adjusted to maintain the proper gasket compression by relocating the pins in the rod guides. When the pin is removed, the latch rod can also be removed. These kits are available with a key locking handle, a non-locking handle or a padlocking handle. All openings through the door are gasketed to assure a complete seal. Ends of latch rods have rollers for easier door closing. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number AL36A Handle Type Padlock AL2A AL2ACCW AL3A AL36BR Keylock Keylock NonLocking Padlock AL2BR Opens Either Clockwise or Counterclockwise Clockwise Counterclockwise Clockwise Description 1-point Latch kit Keylock Either Clockwise or Counterclockwise Clockwise AL2BCCW Keylock Counterclockwise AL3BR NonLocking Padlock Clockwise 3-point Latch Kit where A is 16, 20, 24 or 30 in. 3-point Latch Kit where A is 16, 20, 24 or 30 in. 3-point Latch Kit where A is 16, 20, 24 or 30 in. 3-point Latch Kit where A is 16, 20, 24 or 30 in. 3-point Latch kit where A is 36, 42 or 48 in. AL36CR AL2CR AL2CCCW AL3CR AL36DR AL2DR AL2DCCW AL3DR Keylock Keylock NonLocking Padlock Keylock Keylock NonLocking Either Clockwise or Counterclockwise Clockwise Counterclockwise Clockwise Either Clockwise or Counterclockwise Clockwise Counterclockwise Clockwise 1-point Latch kit 1-point Latch kit 1-point Latch kit 3-point Latch kit where A is 36, 42 or 48 in. 3-point Latch kit where A is 36, 42 or 48 in. 3-point Latch kit where A is 36, 42 or 48 in. 3-point Latch kit where A is 60 or 72 in. 3-point Latch kit where A is 60 or 72 in. 3-point Latch kit where A is 60 or 72 in. 3-point Latch kit where A is 60 or 72 in. See price list for factory installation charges. A is enclosure height. Latch Kits for Type 4 and 12 Enclosures Fits Type 4 and 12 enclosures which have external screw clamps. Requires only a quarter-turn (90 degrees) to open or close. An internal O-ring and external gasket assure a water-tight and dust-tight seal. Installation requires a hole punched or drilled in the door for each latch. Complete instructions are furnished. A square or triangular key is required for tamper-resistant latches. Latch is die-cast zinc with chrome finish. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number AL31 AL32 AL32Y AL35 AL35Y Description Slotted insert 7-mm square insert Key for AL32 7-mm triangle insert Key for AL 35 Toggle Latch for Type 4 and 4X Floor-Mount and Free-Stand Enclosures Provides quick access to Type 4 and 4X floor-mount and free-stand enclosures with clamps. The 3/8-16 threaded, stainless steel toggle latches replace the standard stainless steel bolts. Operation of the toggle releases the door clamp so the door can be opened without tools. Two Type 316 stainless steel toggle assemblies included. Catalog Number AFT44XSS Bulletin: A80 1338 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com Description 2 toggle latches CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Locks, Lockouts, Latches, Handles and Clamps Handles POWERGLIDE® Handles Handles Easy-to-install medium-size POWERGLIDE Handles fit into existing handle holes. They are available in clockwise and counter-clockwise non-defeater models and a clockwise defeater model. The clockwise defeater model includes door hardware for Bulletin A25 enclosures. Catalog Number AL55CW AL55CCW AL55CWD Description Medium POWERGLIDE Handle - Clockwise Opening Medium POWERGLIDE Handle - Counter-Clockwise Opening Medium POWERGLIDE Handle - Clockwise Opening with Defeater and Door Hardware Catalog Number DHDLK Description Handle kit Bulletin: A80 Handle Kit Non-metallic handle for small enclosures. Includes four rubber bumpers that mount on back of enclosure to protect exterior finish. All mounting hardware and complete installation instructions are provided. Bulletin: A80 Handles Attach to sides of enclosure to provide maximum operator control when using a pendant arm, swivel or swivel tilt. Bulletin: C2, CC1, CC2, DEC1, P1 Description 132 mm 177 mm 266 mm 248 mm 9.75 in. Catalog Number ERCFH3U ERCFH4U ERCFH6U PUHKA PUHK Fits Desktop case Desktop case Desktop case PROLINE sloped fronts PROLINE sloped fronts POWERGLIDE® Defeater Handle Kit This clockwise defeater model includes door hardware for Bulletin A25 enclosures. Catalog Number AL55CWD Description Medium POWERGLIDE Handle - Clockwise opening with defeater and door hardware Bulletin: A80 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1339 Accessories: Locks, Lockouts, Latches, Handles and Clamps Clamps Clamps Fast-Operating Clamp-Cover Junction Box Clamp Provides quick access to enclosure or wireway interiors. Installs on standard clamp bracket used on Hoffman junction boxes, Type 12 trough and wireway, Type 4X wireway and similar custom enclosures. Clamps are available in plated steel or stainless steel. Catalog Number AL23 AL23SS Description Plated steel clamp Stainless steel clamp Catalog Number AFC412SS Qty. 2 Bulletin: A80 Fast-Operating Clamp Assembly Provides quick access to enclosures which have screw clamps. Install on clamp brackets used on single-door Type 4, 4X, 12 and 13 enclosures and similar custom order enclosures. The entire clamp assembly is Type 316 stainless steel. Bulletin: A80 Clamp Kits These kits provide replacement clamps for clamp-cover junction boxes and wall-mount enclosures. Each kit contains two clamps and all mounting hardware. Catalog Number AL15 AL16 AL17 AL18 Material Mild Steel Stainless Steel Mild Steel Stainless Steel Use with A12 enclosures A4, A4S enclosures A51 junction boxes A51S junction boxes Bulletin: A80 Clamp Block Kit Used on floor-mount and free-stand Type 4X stainless steel enclosures with clamps. Kit includes two sets of screws, two Type 316L clamp blocks and mounting hardware. Catalog Number ACBK6SS Description 2 clamp blocks and screw sets Bulletin: A50Y CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1340 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Drip Shields Drip Shields Drip Shield Kit for Type 12 Enclosures Drip Shields Drip Shields Protects door hardware from dripping water and settling dust. Attaches quickly and easily to the enclosure with stainless steel screws and sealing washers (hardware is furnished). Stainless steel hinge pin and stainless steel door clamping assemblies are furnished to replace the standard hinge pin and door clamping assemblies. A tube of sealing compound is also supplied with each kit. Manufactured from 14 gauge steel with an ANSI 61 gray polyester powder paint finish over pretreated surfaces. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number ADK12A ADK16A ADK20A ADK24A ADK30A ADK36A ADK42A ADK48A ADK60A ADK72A For Single-Door Wall-Mount Enclosures Single-Door Wall-Mount Enclosures Single-Door Wall-Mount Enclosures Single-Door Wall-Mount Enclosures Single-Door Wall-Mount Enclosures Single-Door Wall-Mount Enclosures Two-Door Floor-Mount Enclosures Two-Door Floor-Mount Enclosures Two-Door Floor-Mount Enclosures Two-Door Floor-Mount Enclosures Fits Enclosure Size B (in.) 12.00 16.00 20.00 24.00 30.00 36.00 42.00 48.00 60.00 72.00 Fits Enclosure Size B (mm) 305 406 508 610 762 914 1067 1219 1524 1829 Two-Door Drip Shield kits are not designed for use on 48.00-in. (1219-mm) wide and 60.00-in. (1524-mm) wide Two-Door Type 12 Wall-Mount Enclosures. Stainless Steel Drip Shield Kit for Type 4 and 4X Wall-Mount Enclosures Easily installed on Type 4 and 4X wall-mount enclosures (excluding quick-release latch models). Protects door from dripping water and settling dust. Attaches quickly and easily to the enclosure with stainless steel screws and sealing washers (furnished). A tube of sealing compound is supplied with each kit. Manufactured from 14 gauge Type 316 stainless steel. Kits can be special ordered for other Hoffman enclosures. Consult factory for more information. Product maintains UL/CSA Type 4, 4X and 12 rating when properly installed on a Hoffman enclosure. Bulletin: A4SY Catalog Number ADK12SS6 ADK16SS6 ADK20SS6 ADK24SS6 ADK30SS6 ADK36SS6 Fits Enclosure Size B (in.) 12.00 16.00 20.00 24.00 30.00 36.00 Fits Enclosure Size B (mm) 305 406 508 610 762 914 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1341 Accessories: Hole Seals Hole Seals Hole Seals Hole Seals HOL-SEALERS® Hole Seals Industry Standards Application Steel Hole Seals Seal extra pushbutton holes, conduit openings and knockout openings against dust, dirt, oil and water with Hoffman HOLSEALERS®. Seals will cover any size or shape of hole from .19-in. diameter to maximum diameter shown in table. Can be used on enclosure walls up to .31-in. (8-mm) thick. UL 508A Component Recognized; Type 3R, 4, 12, 13; File No. E61997 CSA File No. 42186; Type 3R, 4, 12, 13 NEMA/EEMAC Type 3R, 4, 12, 13 IEC 60529, IP66 Features •• A vailable in multiple colors and sizes •• Oil-resistant gasket provided Stainless Steel Hole Seals UL 508A Component Recognized; Type 3R, 4, 4X, 12, 13; File No. E61997 CSA File No. 42186; Type 3R, 4, 4X, 12, 13 NEMA/EEMAC Type 3R, 4, 4X, 12, 13 IEC 60529, IP66 Specifications Steel Models •• 16 gauge galvanized steel backplate •• Plated stud (10-32x5/8) and wing nut Stainless Steel Models •• 16 gauge stainless steel backplate •• Seal, backplate, stud (10-24x5/8) and wing nut are 300 series stainless steel Finish Steel seals have polyester powder paint finish over galvanized front surface. Stainless steel seals have polished front surface. Bulletin: A80HS CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1342 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Hole Seals Hole Seals Standard Product Catalog Number AS056M Material Steel Finish/Color ANSI 61 gray For Micro AS056MSS Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Micro AS056CB Steel Chrysler beige Micro AS056MFB Steel Ford brown Micro AS056MLG Steel Light gray Micro ASPBG Steel ANSI 61 gray 22.5-mm pushbutton holes ASPBGSS Stainless Steel Stainless Steel 22.5-mm pushbutton holes AS050 Steel ANSI 61 gray 1/2-in. conduit holes AS050LG Steel Light gray 1/2-in. conduit holes AS050SS Stainless Steel Stainless Steel 1/2-in. conduit holes AS075 Steel ANSI 61 gray 3/4-in. conduit holes AS075SS Stainless Steel Stainless Steel 3/4-in. conduit holes AS075LG Steel Light gray 3/4-in. conduit holes ASPB Steel ANSI 61 gray 30.5-mm pushbutton holes ASPBSS Stainless Steel Stainless Steel 30.5-mm pushbutton holes ASPBLG Steel Light gray 30.5-mm pushbutton holes AS100 Steel ANSI 61 gray 1-in. conduit holes AS100SS Stainless Steel Stainless Steel 1-in. conduit holes AS100LG Steel Light gray 1-in. conduit holes AS125 Steel ANSI 61 gray 1 1/4-in. conduit holes AS125SS Stainless Steel Stainless Steel 1 1/4-in. conduit holes AS125LG Steel Light gray 1 1/4-in. conduit holes AS150 Steel ANSI 61 gray 1 1/2-in. conduit holes AS150SS Stainless Steel Stainless Steel 1 1/2-in. conduit holes AS150LG Steel Light gray 1 1/2-in. conduit holes AS200 Steel ANSI 61 gray 2-in. conduit holes AS200SS Stainless Steel Stainless Steel 2-in. conduit holes AS200LG Steel Light gray 2-in. conduit holes AS250 Steel ANSI 61 gray 2 1/2-in. conduit holes AS250SS Stainless Steel Stainless Steel 2 1/2-in. conduit AS300 Steel ANSI 61 gray 3-in. conduit holes AS300SS Stainless Steel Stainless Steel 3-in. conduit holes AS350 Steel ANSI 61 gray 3 1/2-in. conduit holes AS350SS Stainless Steel Stainless Steel 3 1/2-in. conduit holes AS400 Steel ANSI 61 gray 4-in. conduit holes AS400SS Stainless Steel Stainless Steel 4-in. conduit holes Maximum Hole Diameter in./mm 0.56 14 0.56 14 0.56 14 0.56 14 0.56 14 0.88 22 0.88 22 0.88 22 0.88 22 0.88 22 1.06 27 1.06 27 1.06 27 1.25 32 1.25 32 1.25 32 1.38 35 1.38 35 1.38 35 1.69 43 1.69 43 1.69 43 2.00 51 2.00 51 2.00 51 2.50 64 2.50 64 2.50 64 3.00 76 3.00 76 3.62 92 3.62 92 4.12 105 4.12 105 4.62 117 4.62 117 Hol-Sealer Diameter in./mm 0.80 20 0.80 20 0.80 20 0.80 20 0.80 20 1.22 31 1.22 31 1.38 35 1.38 35 1.38 35 1.56 40 1.56 40 1.56 40 1.75 44 1.75 44 1.75 44 1.88 48 1.88 48 1.88 48 2.19 56 2.19 56 2.19 56 2.50 64 2.50 64 2.50 64 3.00 76 3.00 76 3.00 76 3.50 89 3.50 89 4.12 105 4.12 105 4.62 117 4.62 117 5.12 130 5.12 130 CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1343 Accessories: Hole Seals Hole Seals HOL-SEALERS® Non-Metallic Hole Seals Industry Standards Features UL 508A Component Recognized; Type 3R, 4, 4X, 12, 13; File No. E61997 CSA File No. 42186: Type 3R, 4, 4X, 12, 13 NEMA/EEMAC Type 3R, 4, 4X, 12, 13 IEC 60529, IP66 Application Designed for use in corrosive environments to seal extra pushbutton holes, conduit openings and knockout openings against dust, dirt, oil and water. These hole seals are suitable for sealing enclosure openings in industries such as petroleum and chemical processing, wastewater processing, pulp and paper, outdoor monitoring and any other industry exposed to harsh environments. Innovative 3-in-1 self-centering design •• Thread self-centers on one hole size •• Nut orientation “A” self-centers on a second hole size (see Nut Orientation drawing) •• Nut orientation “B” self-centers on a third hole size •• I nnovative 3-in-1 self-centering design reduces inventory requirements; 4 models cover 12 common industry cutouts ranging from 1/2 in. to 4 in. •• Non-metallic construction provides superior corrosion resistance for reliability in harsh environments •• UV stabilized; ideal for direct sunlight (avoids fiberbloom associated with fiberglass) •• Chemically resistant to a broad range of chemicals •• Durable and impact resistant; resists cracking •• Sold in quantities of 2 per catalog number •• Cost-effective alternative to stainless steel •• Polyester material has a UL 94 rating of 5VA •• Easy to install; no tools required Specifications •• T hread and nut are constructed of non-glass-filled polyester •• Oil-resistant gasket Finish RAL 7035 light-gray textured finish Bulletin: A80HS Standard Product Non-Metallic Hole Seals Catalog Number ASPB05075NM ASPB100125NM AS150200250NM AS300350400NM AxBxC in./mm 1.56 x 0.85 x 0.12 40 x 22 x 3 2.19 x 1.19 x 0.12 56 x 30 x 3 3.50 x 1.95 x 0.12 89 x 49 x 3 5.12 x 3.55 x 0.12 130 x 90 x 3 D in./mm 1.28 32 1.18 30 .95 24 .81 21 Qty. 2 2 2 2 E in./mm 1.48 38 2.14 54 3.42 87 5.05 128 F in./mm .47 12 .51 13 .51 13 .51 13 Max. Hole Diameter in./mm 1.28 33 1.91 49 3.14 80 4.77 121 Outside Diameter in./mm 1.56 40 2.19 56 3.50 89 5.12 130 Torque (in.-lb.) 15 20 35 50 CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1344 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Hole Seals Hole Seals HOL-SEALERS® Fit These Hole Sizes Catalog Number ASPB05075NM ASPB100125NM AS150200250NM AS300350400NM Fits .5-in. conduit holes 22.5-mm pushbutton holes .75-in. conduit holes 30.5-mm pushbutton holes 1-in. conduit holes 1.25-in. conduit holes 1.5-in. conduit holes 2-in. conduit holes 2.5-in. conduit holes 3-in. conduit holes 3.5-in. conduit holes 4-in. conduit holes Min. Hole Dia. (inch) .86 .88 1.09 1.20 1.36 1.70 1.95 2.38 2.88 3.50 4.00 4.50 Min. Hole Dia. (millimeter) 22 22 28 31 35 43 50 60 73 89 102 114 Nut Orientation A A A A B A A B A A B A CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1345 Corrosion Inhibitors Corrosion Inhibitors Corrosion Inhibitors Industrial Corrosion Inhibitors Accessories: Corrosion Inhibitors CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Life Expectancy and Usage The normal useful life-span of Hoffman corrosion inhibitors is in excess of one year. However, inhibitor life expectancy is shortened by approximately 25 percent when exposed to temperatures above 104 F (40 C). This product is not recommended for use where temperature exceeds 199 F. Since Hoffman corrosion inhibitors are vapor-phase protective, all surfaces to be protected should be accessible to the vapors. The maximum distance the vapors can travel is approximately 1.50 ft. (.46 m). Protection of long, narrow enclosures can be achieved with tape or multiple inhibitors. Storage and Handling Each Hoffman corrosion inhibitor is individually packaged in a resealable bag for maximum effectiveness at the time of usage. Corrosion inhibitors should be stored at temperatures not exceeding 120 F (45 C ). Hoffman corrosion inhibitors are not returnable. When determining the proper corrosion inhibitor for your application, assume the enclosure volume to be protected is greater than calculated if (1) cabinet doors are opened frequently, (2) cabinet is located in an extremely corrosive area and/or (3) cabinet length divided by depth is greater than four. AHCI1DV Foam device protects one cubic foot (28 liters) of enclosure volume for approximately one year. Size: .25 x 1.25 x 3.00 in. (6 x 32 x 76 mm) AHCI5E Emitter protects 5 ft.3 (142 liters) of enclosure volume for Hoffman corrosion inhibitors protect approximately two years from the date of manufacture. Emitters •• Interior components of electrical enclosures, boxes, consoles and contain additional red metal (non-ferrous) inhibitors. wireways Size: 2.31 in. (diameter) x 0.81 in. (high) (59 mm x 21 mm) •• Interior components of electronic enclosures AHCI10E •• Electrical and electronic equipment and controls 3 •• Parts and components that are packaged in crates during shipping Emitter protects 10 ft. (283 liters) of enclosure volume for approximately two years from the date of manufacture. Emitters and storage contain additional red metal (non-ferrous) inhibitors. •• Switch gear and relay cabinets Size: 2.31 in. (diameter) x 1.38 in. (high) (59 mm x 35 mm) •• Interiors of pipes, conduits and fuse boxes AHCI60R •• Process control computers, instruments and recording devices Tape protects 60 ft.3 of enclosure volume per roll. Use approximately •• Tool chest interiors and contents 2.50 in. (63 mm) of tape per cubic foot (28 liters) of enclosure volume •• Equipment stored at construction sites to be protected. Each roll of tape is packaged individually in a Chief Advantages resealable bag. •• Protects against salt and high humidity Size: .25 in. x .75 in. x 12.00 ft. (6 mm x 19 mm x 3.6 m) •• Eliminates the need of oiling, plating or dipping metal •• Puts protected equipment to use immediately without degreasing AHCI240R Tape protects 240 ft.3 of enclosure volume per roll. Use approximately or coating removal 1.00 in. (25 mm) of tape per cubic foot (28 liters) of enclosure volume How They Work Each inhibitor contains a special chemical combination that vaporizes to be protected. Each roll of tape is packaged individually in a resealable bag. and condenses on all surfaces in an enclosed area. Vapors will Size: .25 in. x 2.00 in. x 20.00 ft. (6 mm x 51 mm x 6.1 m) redeposit as needed in the event of condensation of moisture on surfaces. These vapors reach every part of an enclosure, protecting all AHCI238S Spray is a non-conductive, nonflammable, vapor-phase film and is interior components. Spraying, wiping or greasing are not required. non-toxic. It has essentially neutral pH value. Application provides This eliminates precoating, special wraps and drying agents. instant protection against corrosion. Spray is water soluble and can Protection is effective even in salt-water atmospheres. The AHCI5E and AHCI10E emitters have additional red-metal inhibitors for further be easily flushed away with water if desired. This product should be kept from freezing and has a shelf life of 2+ years in normal protection. Enclosures containing corrosion inhibitors must be warehouse conditions. reasonably sealed. Bulletin: A80 Standard Product Catalog Number AHCI1DV AHCI5E AHCI10E AHCI60R AHCI240R AHCI238S Enclosure Volume Protected (ft.3 ) 1 5 10 60 per roll 240 per roll Corrosion Inhibitor Spray Enclosure Volume Protected (liters) 28.32 141.6 283.2 1699 per roll 6797 per roll Corrosion Inhibitor Spray Protected by Chemical Marked reduction of surface attack; no pitting Decreased tarnish; very minor surface attack No change Slight staining Slight discoloration Slight discoloration Unprotected by Chemical Severe surface attack; tarnish; pitting Surface discoloration; pitting Severe corrosion Heavy corrosive attack Severe corrosion Moderate corrosive attack Package Qty. 50 25 12 3 1 6 Metal Protection Chart Metal Aluminum Brassa Steel, Iron Coppera Zinc Plate Tin Plate a AHCI5E and AHCI1OE emitters are recommended for these materials 1346 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Corrosion Inhibitors Corrosion Inhibitors Epoxy Patch Kit Applications include sealing rivets, bolts, metal joints, seams and welds, cement cracks, pipe couplings, joints and tees. Each kit has two tubes of material, application instructions and a mixing stick. When the resin and hardener are mixed, a gray epoxy is formed which cures at room temperature, has high adhesion and will not sag. It is resistant to oils, acids and chemicals. Catalog Number A307 Description Epoxy Patch Kit Bulletin: A80 Touch-Up Paint Hoffman Touch-Up Paint is used to repair the finish of enclosures and panels. Furnished in 12-oz. spray cans. Bulletin: A80, DACCY, P20 Catalog Number ATPWE ATPSG ATPPY61 ATPDLB ATPMG ATPHS61 ATPFG ATPG7035 ATPG7032 ATPB7021 ATPB9005 Color White Enamel Gray Enamel ANSI 61 Gray Polyester Powder DesignLine Beige Enamel Slate Gray Enamel High Solids ANSI 61 Gray Light Gray for fiberglass RAL 7035 Gray RAL 7032 Gray RAL 7021 Black RAL 9005 Black CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1347 Accessories: Electrical Accessories Terminal Block Kits Terminal Block Kit Assembly for Junction Boxes Overview Electrical Accessories Terminal Block Kits Provides a strong, versatile and easily installed means for mounting terminal blocks in Hoffman junction boxes and other enclosures. These kits can be installed in: 1. Oil-Tight Junction Boxes 2. Fiberglass Type 4X Enclosures 3. Hinged Cover Lift-Off Type 3R Enclosures (16 gauge only) These kits will NOT fit in Small Wall-Mount Enclosures or HCR Type 3R Enclosures. How To Order Terminal Kit Assemblies can be installed with the terminal straps or terminal strips parallel to the A dimension or the B dimension of the box. Each box requires one bracket assembly plus the desired number of terminal straps or terminal block strips. The bracket assembly and the terminal straps or terminal block strips must be ordered separately. 1. To select the correct terminal straps or terminal block strips, determine whether they will be mounted parallel to the A dimension or parallel to the B dimension of the box. Be sure to specify the quantity required. 2. To select the correct bracket assembly, determine whether the brackets will be mounted parallel to the A dimension or to the B dimension of the box. Component Bracket Assembly Terminal Straps Terminal Block Strips Quantity 1 As required for installation; specify when ordering As required for installation; specify when ordering Comments Mount parallel to A or B dimension Use straps or strips Use straps or strips CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1348 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Electrical Accessories Terminal Block Kits Terminal Block Bracket Assemblies for Junction Boxes Each bracket assembly consists of two brackets which mount on the weldnuts in the box. White finish over pretreated surfaces. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number A6JTMA Enclosure Dimension Parallel to Brackets 6 A8JTMA 8 A10JTMA 10 A10JTMAXK 10 A12JTMA 12 A14JTMA 14 K in./mm 1.44 37 1.44 37 1.44 37 2.69 68 2.69 68 2.69 68 Terminal Box Straps for Junction Boxes A terminal strap is a 12 gauge flat strap which mounts on top of the brackets. The straps can be positioned anywhere along the brackets and are held in place with spring locking nuts. White finish over pretreated surfaces. Terminal blocks are not included with terminal straps. Does not work with DIN rail-mounted terminal blocks. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number A8JS Enclosure Dimension Parallel to Straps 8 A10JS 10 A12JS 12 A14JS 14 A16JS 16 K in./mm 1.44 37 1.44 37 1.44 37 2.69 68 2.69 68 M in./mm 5.75 146 7.75 197 9.75 248 11.70 297 13.70 348 Terminal Block Strips for Junction Boxes A terminal block strip is a flat channel holding Buchanan 600V terminal blocks with tubular clamp contacts assembled on the channel. These terminal blocks will accept wire sizes from #22 through #10. The number of terminal blocks assembled on each channel is shown in the table. The terminal block strips can be positioned anywhere along the brackets and are held in place with spring locking nuts. The channel has a plated finish. Terminal blocks are included with terminal block strips. Marathon terminal blocks can be provided on special order. Other brands and sizes of terminal blocks are available on special order. Catalog Number A8JBNS Enclosure Dimension Parallel to Strips 8 Terminal Blocks per Strip 8 A10JBNS 10 12 A12JBNS 12 16 A14JBNS 14 20 A16JBNS 16 24 Bulletin: A80 M in./mm 5.75 146 7.75 197 9.75 248 11.75 298 13.75 349 L in./mm 5.00 127 7.00 178 9.00 229 9.00 229 11.00 279 13.00 330 Useable Space, N in./mm 4.62 117 6.62 168 8.62 219 10.62 270 12.62 321 Useable Space, N in./mm 4.62 117 6.62 168 8.62 219 10.62 270 12.62 321 P in./mm 3.00 76 3.00 76 3.00 76 4.25 108 4.25 108 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1349 Accessories: Electrical Accessories Terminal Block Kits Terminal Block Kit Assembly for Type 4, 12 and 13 Enclosures Overview One bracket is required for each row of collar studs parallel to the brackets. As a result, if the enclosure dimension is 24.00 in. (610 mm), 30.00 in. (762 mm) or 36.00 in. (914 mm) and if two brackets are needed to cover all of the collar studs order A___NTMA2; if three brackets are needed to cover the studs order A___NTMA3. For example: If you have an A302406LP enclosure and want five terminal straps running vertically, order one A24NTMA2 bracket assembly plus five A30T straps. If you have an A483008LP enclosure and want six terminal straps running vertically, order one A30NTMA3 bracket assembly plus six A48T straps. If you have an A363006LP enclosure and want seven terminal straps running horizontally, order one A36NTMA2 bracket assembly plus seven A30T straps. Provide strong, versatile and easily installed terminal block mounting supports. These assemblies fit many single-door Hoffman enclosures. They also fit large Type 1 enclosures and the larger sizes of Hinged Cover Lift-Off Type 3R enclosures as well as most of the Two-Door Wall-Mounted Type 12 enclosures. Kits have white finish over pretreated surfaces. Terminal Block Kit Assemblies can be installed with straps parallel to the A dimension or the B dimension of the enclosure. Terminal blocks are not included. Be sure to order one bracket assembly plus the desired number of terminal straps for each enclosure. Component Bracket Assembly Terminal Straps Terminal Strap Support Kit Qty Required 1 Depends on installation One kit per strap Comments Terminal blocks are not included Specify quantity when ordering Optional How To Order Each enclosure requires one bracket assembly plus the desired number of terminal straps. The bracket assembly and the terminal straps must be ordered separately. 1. To select the correct terminal straps, determine whether the terminal straps will be mounted parallel to the A dimension or the B dimension of the enclosure. Be sure to specify the quantity required. 2. To select the correct bracket assembly, determine whether the brackets will be mounted parallel to the A dimension or the B dimension of the enclosure. Refer to the table. Bracket Assembly for Type 4, 12 and 13 Enclosures Each bracket assembly consists of two or three brackets which mount on the enclosure collar studs. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number A12NTMA2 A16NTMA2 A20NTMA2 A24NTMA2 A24NTMA3 A30NTMA2 A30NTMA3 A36NTMA3 Number of Brackets 2 2 2 2 3 2 3 3 Enclosure Dimension Parallel to Brackets (in.) 12.00 16.00 20.00 24.00 24.00 30.00 30.00 36.00 Enclosure Dimension Parallel to Brackets (mm) 305 406 508 610 610 762 762 914 Bracket Length, L (in.) 8.50 12.50 16.50 20.50 20.50 26.50 26.50 32.50 Bracket Length, L (mm) 216 318 419 521 521 673 673 826 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1350 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Electrical Accessories Terminal Block Kits Terminal Straps for Type 4, 12 and 13 Enclosures The terminal straps can be positioned anywhere along the brackets and are held in place with spring locking nuts. This feature makes wiring easy and simplifies the addition of terminal straps at a later date. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number A16T A20T A24T A30T A36T A42T A48T A60T Enclosure Dimension Parallel to Straps 16 20 24 30 36 42 48 60 Terminal Strap Support Kit M (in.) 13.00 17.00 21.00 27.00 33.00 39.00 45.00 57.00 M (mm) 330 432 533 686 838 991 1143 1448 Useable Space, N (in.) 11.75 15.75 19.75 25.75 31.75 37.75 43.75 55.75 Useable Space, N (mm) 298 400 502 654 806 959 1111 1416 Designed to provide a simple and versatile method of mounting terminal straps. The Z-shaped brackets are 1.50-in. (38-mm) high with white finish. Brackets can be attached to panels or to enclosure walls. A terminal strap is then installed on the brackets. Terminal straps must be ordered separately. Two brackets are furnished with each kit. Spacing between brackets will depend on the number and size of terminal blocks installed on the terminal strap. We recommend a maximum spacing of 15 in. (381 mm) for an average installation. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number ATZ Description Two Z-shaped brackets Terminal strap NOT included. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1351 Accessories: Electrical Accessories Grounding DIN Type Rails Grounding Catalog Number ADNR1 ADNR3 ACENR1 Description DIN 1 mounting rail TS32 DIN 3 mounting rail TS35x7.5 CENELEC mounting rail TS35x15 DIN Type Rails receive terminal blocks, relays, switches, filters, timers and various other electrical and electronic components manufactured by European, Japanese and U.S. firms. Available in three styles: (1) asymmetric, DIN 1 profile; (2) symmetric, DIN 3 profile; (3) heavy-duty CENELEC profile. All DIN rails are 78.74-in. (2000-mm) long and plated. Bulletin: A80 Grounding Device Grounding lug is designed to provide a means of attaching a grounding conductor to an electrical enclosure. Will accept wire sizes 2 through 14. Grounding Straps can be used to provide electrical continuity between metal parts which must be electrically connected. Each strap consists of a length of braided copper with a ring terminal at both ends. Braid is insulated with green and yellow striped plastic. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number AGS808 AGS816 AGS408 AGS416 AGLK2 Description Grounding Strap Grounding Strap Grounding Strap Grounding Strap Grounding lug kit Approximate Wire Size (AWG) #8 #8 #4 #4 2-14 Grounding Bar System Length Between Ring Terminals C-to-C (in.) 8.19 16.19 8.19 16.19 — Length Between Ring Terminals C-to-C (mm) 208 411 208 411 — Ring Terminal Hole Diameter (in.) 0.406 0.406 0.406 0.406 — Ring Terminal Hole Diameter (mm) 10 10 10 10 — Industry Standards UL Component Recognized; File No. E61997 Three sizes of grounding bars and insulated mounting brackets are available. Bars are plated copper with M6 and M5 tapped holes to provide a common point for grounding equipment. Fits all enclosures if mounted vertically. See table for horizontal mounting. Bulletin: P20 Catalog Number PGS2K PGS4K PGS6K Description Fits 400-mm deep frame front to back horizontally Fits 600-mm deep frame front to back horizontally Fits 800-mm deep frame front to back horizontally Length mm/in. 200 7.87 400 15.75 600 23.62 Number of Holes and Screws M6 3/5 Number of Holes and Screws M5 10/10 9/11 20/20 15/17 30/31 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1352 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Electrical Accessories Grounding PROLINE® Grounding Kit The Grounding Kit allows a PROLINE® enclosure to be grounded to VDE specifications. Includes six 12 gauge wires 411-mm (16.19-in.) long with ring terminations and M6 mounting hardware. Catalog Number PGK Wire Size 12 ga. Length Between Ring Terminals mm/in. 411 16.19 Ring Terminal Hole Diameter mm/in. 7 .29 Bulletin: P9 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1353 Accessories: Electrical Accessories Electrical Interlocks Electrical Interlocks Electrical Interlocks The interlocks will fit the following enclosures, but modifications are required. Consult the factory for more information. 1. Two-door Type 12 enclosures for flange-mounted disconnects 2. Heavy duty free-standing Type 12 enclosures for flangemounted disconnects 3. Modular Type 12 enclosures for flange-mounted disconnects 4. Multi-door Type 12 enclosures The interlocks will also fit most Hoffman custom enclosures with door latching mechanisms similar to the mechanisms used on the preceding enclosures. Electrical interlocks will not fit CONCEPT® enclosures or Bulletin A25 and A26 enclosures. Interlocks are not designed to be used in place of the standard door or cover latch. Catalog numbers AEK115NDH, AEK230NDH and AEK460NDH are designed to be used on some Hoffman enclosures and boxes which have exterior latching only. When energized, these interlocks will prevent the enclosure door from being opened. They fit on the door or cover of the following enclosures and maintain UL Type 4, 4X and 12 when properly installed per Hoffman instructions: 1. One-door Type 4 and 4X enclosures 2. Two-door Type 4 and 4X enclosures 3. One-door Type 12 enclosures 4. Larger sizes of CH, CHS, CHNF, CHNFSS and CHAL junction boxes 5. Type 1 and large Type 1 enclosures The interlocks also fit in most Hoffman custom enclosures and boxes which have doors or covers hinged similar to doors or covers on the preceding enclosures. Industry Standards UL 508A Component Recognized; File No. E61997 CSA Certified; File No. 42186 Application Provide positive internal safety lockout on electrical enclosures while the equipment is energized. Catalog numbers AEK115, AEK230 and AEK460 are used with standard Hoffman door latching mechanisms. When energized, these interlocks prevent the door handle from being turned to open the door. Fit either clockwise or counterclockwise handles in the following enclosures: 1. All two-door Type 4 and 12 enclosures 2. All Type 4X with 3-point latch enclosures 3. Free-standing Type 12 enclosures 4. All one-door Type 12 enclosures with latch kits installed Installation AEK115, AEK230 and AEK460 mount on the inside of the enclosure door using the same screws which hold the door handle in place. The strike plate attaches to the existing latch assembly. Specifications •• R ugged steel construction and plated finish •• Solenoids are rated for continuous duty and will stand up under heavy industrial use •• Packaged complete with a solenoid assembly, strike plate or bracket and instructions for field installation •• Handles and latch mechanisms are not included. Bulletin: A80 Standard Product A-EK___ Style Catalog Number AEK115 AEK230 AEK460 Volts @ 50/60 Hz 110/120 220/240 440/480 Normal/Inrush Amps @ 60 Hz .100/.63 .050/.32 .025/.16 Normal/Inrush Amps @ 50 Hz .120/.69 .060/.35 .030/.18 Normal/Inrush Amps @ 60 Hz .100/.63 .050/.32 .025/.16 Normal/Inrush Amps @ 50 Hz .120/.69 .060/.35 .030/.18 Standard Product AEK___NDH Style Catalog Number AEK115NDH AEK230NDH AEK460NDH Volts @ 50/60Hz 110/120 220/240 440/480 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1354 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Electrical Accessories Electrical Interlocks CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1355 Accessories: Electrical Accessories Electrical Interlocks Electrical Interlock Defeater Enables authorized personnel to enter an enclosure while the enclosure contents are energized. Defeater is a key-operated momentary contact switch with contacts normally closed. Turning the key disengages the circuit to the electrical interlock. Can be used with all 110/120 volt Hoffman electrical interlocks. A relay must be used in conjunction with switch for 220/240 volt and 440/480 volt applications. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number AEKDF Panel Interface Connector Description Electrical interlock defeater Amps @ 120V/60 Hz Normal/ Inrush 10 Max. Amps @ 110V/50 Hz Normal/ Inrush 10 Max. The panel interface connector provides a connection for a PLC or computer housed inside an enclosure without opening the enclosure door. It mounts on the outside of the enclosure. The HBE size 32 housing and hinged cover are die cast aluminum. The closed assembly is rated UL Type 4. The panel interface connector enclosure includes: •• •• •• •• •• duplex receptacle A A 9-pin D-sub pass-through connector An RJ 45 pass-through connector A 3-amp reset A covered terminal block with screw connections for the internal power connection Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number AC4DB9RJ45GFI Description Panel Interface Connector Industry Standards UL 508A Component Recognized; File No. E61997 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1356 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Electrical Accessories Electrical Interlocks Notes CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1357 Accessories: Electrical Accessories Lighting Packages Lighting Packages PANELITE™ Enclosure Lights Overview Industry Standards UL 508A Component Recognized; File No. E61997 cUL Component Recognized per CSA C22.2 No 14; File No. E61997 CSA File No. 42186 Maintains UL/CSA Type 4, 4X and 12 enclosure rating when properly installed in a Hoffman enclosure. Application Versatile, slim-profile LED and fluorescent lights provide mounting flexibility and are easy to install in any enclosure. Terminal blocks on both ends of the light allow for easy wiring. Accessories include ganging cables, power cords and door switches, all provided with plug-and-play connectors for easy connection to the terminal blocks with an innovative terminal connection system. LED version provides superior lighting performance with minimal power consumption. •• O n/off switch incorporated in light; optional remote door switch accessory available to activate light when enclosure door is opened •• Up to five lights can be daisy-chained together •• Plug-and-play terminal connection system: - Pre-wired connection sockets on both ends of light allow use of Hoffman cable accessories - Optional terminal blocks snap into the connection sockets allowing customers to use own wiring methods; two terminal blocks provided with each light kit - Power supply can be wired manually with Hoffman PANELITE Power Cable with Leads or with Hoffman optional PANELITE Power Cord - Ganging cables are available in 2-, 4- and 6-ft. lengths to easily join up to five lights together using one power supply - Remote door switch for easy door activation eliminates need to mount light in the exact location required to activate the light Specifications Features •• S lim profile allows light to be tucked up out of the way for easy panel installation •• Versatile mounting tabs allow the light to be positioned horizontally or vertically; two-way mounting tabs can be installed on front or back of light for ideal orientation •• Mounting tabs provide easy access point for attachment hardware; light does not need to be disassembled for installation •• Includes mounting hardware for the following enclosure installations: PROLINE Frame, Enclosure Top, Panel Mount and Unistrut •• •• •• •• E xtruded aluminum center support Black composite end caps Black composite mounting tabs Each light fixture includes two mounting tabs, two pre-wired connection sockets, two optional terminal blocks that snap into the connection sockets and enclosure attachment hardware (bulb not included with fluorescent light) CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1358 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Electrical Accessories Lighting Packages PANELITE™ LED Enclosure Light •• 2 4 VDC operation for superior lighting performance with minimal power consumption •• 140-degree cone angle casts a broad covering of neutral light •• Center section rotates 120 degrees to re-direct light where needed •• Long life; 70 percent of initial luminance at 50,000 hours (at 25 C) •• High power LED emitters produce 470 Lumens for superior lighting performance; provides up to 50 percent more usable light than comparable length fluorescent lights •• Can be wired using optional PANELITE Cable Accessories or can be hard-wired with terminal blocks included in hardware kit •• Up to five lights can be daisychained together using hard-wired connection to power supply or catalog number LPC72 power cable with leads Catalog Number LED24V15 Description LED Light, 15 in. PP VDC 24 Amps .5 W in./mm 15.00 381 X in./mm 8.00 203 PP PP PP PP Bulletin: A80LT PANELITE™ Fluorescent Enclosure Light •• 1 20 VAC, 50/60 Hz operation •• Can be wired using optional PANELITE™ Cable Accessories or can be hard-wired with terminal blocks included in hardware kit •• Available in 15-, 18- and 28-in. lengths with ability to daisy chain up to five lights together using one power supply •• Fluorescent bulb not included Catalog Number LF120V15 VAC 120 Hz 50/60 Amps .13 LF120V18 120 50/60 .13 LF120V28 120 50/60 .26 W in./mm 14.50 368 17.50 445 27.75 705 X in./mm 9.63 245 12.63 321 22.88 581 Bulb (purchase separately) F6T5 F8T5 F14T5 Bulletin: A80LT PP : ; PP PP CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1359 Accessories: Electrical Accessories Lighting Packages PANELITE™ Power Cords •• C onnects light to standard North American wall socket •• LF120VCORD is for 120 VAC Fluorescent lights (up to five lights can be daisy chained together using one power cord) •• LED24VCORD is for 24 VDC LED lights and includes a transformer to convert 100-240 VAC power supply (capable of powering only one LED light) •• Plugs directly into a connection socket on switch end of the light •• Includes one cable Power cord not required. Terminal blocks are provided with each light for wired connection to electric supply. Catalog Number LF120VCORD LED24VCORD Description Fluorescent Light Power Cord LED Light Power Cord Length 72 in. 60 in. Bulletin: A80LT PANELITE™ Power Cable with Leads •• 7 2-in. power cord provides convenient connection to an electrical supply •• Eliminates need to run and tag individual wires into the light •• Compatible with PANELITE™ LED and Fluorescent lights •• Plugs directly into connection socket on switch end of the light •• Includes one 16 AWG cable, black Power Cable not required. Terminal blocks are provided with each light for wired connection to electric supply. Catalog Number LPC72 Length 72 in. Catalog Number LGCABLE24 LGCABLE48 LGCABLE72 Length 24 in. 48 in. 72 in. Catalog Number LDSWITCH18 LDSWITCH72 Length 18 in. 72 in. Bulletin: A80LT PANELITE™ Ganging Cables •• G anging Cables provide convenient method for joining up to five lights together while utilizing one power supply •• Available in 24-, 48- and 72-in. lengths •• Plugs directly into connection socket on either end of the light •• Compatible with PANELITE™ LED and Fluorescent lights •• Includes one 16 AWG cable, black Ganging Cables not required. Terminal blocks are provided with each light for hard-wired connections. Bulletin: A80LT PANELITE™ Door Switch Cable •• E asily connects PANELITE™ LED or Fluorescent Light to a Remote Door Switch •• T-connector allows the Door Switch Cable to be connected with a ganging cable or power supply to the switch end of the light •• Available in 18- and 72-in. lengths •• Includes one 18 AWG cable, black Door Switch Cables not required. Terminal blocks are provided with each light for hard-wired connection to remote door switch. Bulletin: A80LT 1360 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Electrical Accessories Lighting Packages PANELITE™ Remote Door Switches •• R emote door switch activates the light when the enclosure door is opened •• Mounts on enclosure frame and includes mounting hardware •• Mounting plate is 14 gauge steel with a plated finish •• Can be hard-wired to the PANELITE™ LED or Fluorescent light or connected via the PANELITE Door Switch Cable Catalog Number ALFSWD PLFSWD Description Door switch assembly (order connection cable separately) Door switch assembly for PROLINE® (order connection cable separately) Bulletin: A80LT, P20 PANELITE™ Wiring Options See the table on the drawing for cable clearance dimensions. (OHFWULF3RZHU 2SWLRQ(DFKOLJKWLVFRQWUROOHGE\DUHPRWHGRRUVZLWFK (OHFWULF3RZHU 2SWLRQ$OOOLJKWVDUHFRQWUROOHGE\DVLQJOHUHPRWHGRRUVZLWFK (OHFWULF3RZHU 89046495 2SWLRQ7KHODVWOLJKWLVFRQWUROOHGE\DUHPRWHGRRUVZLWFK7KHILUVWWZROLJKWVDUHPDQXDOO\RSHUDWHG CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1361 Accessories: Electrical Accessories Lighting Packages Mounting Bracket Kit for Light Package Kit simplifies mounting light package in Hoffman PROLINE® disconnect enclosures. Includes brackets, all mounting hardware and complete instructions. Bulletin: A80LT Catalog Number PDLFBRKT Description Mounting Bracket Kit Remote Switches for Light Package Catalog Number ALFSWM ALFSWD PLFSWM PLFSWD a Description Manual Switch Door-Activated Switch Manual Switcha Door-Activated Switcha For installation in PROLINE® Enclosures. Remote switches for the PANELITE™ Enclosure Lights. Mounts on the frame and includes mounting hardware. Mounting plate is 14 gauge steel with a plated finish. Bulletin: A80LT, P20 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1362 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Electrical Accessories Lighting Packages Notes CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1363 Accessories: Electrical Accessories Power Distribution Units Power Distribution Units Rack- and Panel-Mount Power Distribution Units (PDUs) Features •• P ower on/off LED indicates whether power is available at the PDU •• External ground stud provided on single-phase models for secure grounding •• Circuit breakers provide additional equipment protection •• Circuits are isolated on dual circuit model; each has its own circuit breaker •• Reset button provides easy access to circuit breaker reset •• Surge protector models have an indicator LED to verify surge circuitry protection •• Rack-mount models mount directly to rack or with adapter bracket •• Rack-mount models designed for single-phase applications •• Panel-mount models can be mounted flush or with hanging bracket •• Panel-mount models available for both one- and three-phase applications •• Three-phase models have three 20 A, double-pole magnetic breaker/switches with an integral switch guard Specifications Industry Standards •• Steel housing •• Power cord with molded-on plug: - 12-in. (305-mm) long single-phase model: 6 ft. (1.8 m) - Other single-phase models: 15 ft. (4.6 m) - Three-phase models: 10 ft. (3 m) UL/cUL 60950 listed UL 1449 (Surge protector models only) EIA 310-D (19-in. rack-mount models only) Application Rack- and Panel-Mount PDUs not only provide convenient, reliable power to equipment mounted in cabinets or on open frame racks, they can also be configured to meet a wide range of design specifications. Contact Hoffman for custom modifications and non-standard offerings. Finish Black, low-gloss textured paint. Bulletin: DPS Standard Product Single-Phase Rack-Mount Catalog Number DP1N190615 DP1N191415 DP1N191415M DP1N191015S DP1N191020 DP1N191020S DP1N191020ST DP1N191420 DP1N191420T DP1N190430X Surge Protection No No No Yes No Yes Yes No No No Amp Meter No No Yes No No No No No No No Load Rating 15A 15A 15A 15A 20A 20A 20A 20A 20A 30A Voltage (VAC) 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 Joule Rating — — — 2000 — 2000 2000 — — — Receptacle Location Front 6 front, 8 back 6 front, 8 back 2 front, 8 back 2 front, 8 back 2 front, 8 back 2 front, 8 back 6 front, 8 back 6 front, 8 back 4 front, 4 back No. of Receptacles 6 14 14 10 10 10 10 14 14 8 Receptacle Style NEMA 5-15R NEMA 5-15R NEMA 5-15R NEMA 5-15R NEMA 5-20R NEMA 5-20R NEMA 5-20R NEMA 5-20R NEMA 5-20R Front, NEMA 5-15R - 15A; Back, NEMA L5-30R-30A Power Cord Plug NEMA 5-15P NEMA 5-15P NEMA 5-15P NEMA 5-15P NEMA 5-20P NEMA 5-20P NEMA L5-20P Twist Lock NEMA 5-20P NEMA L5-20P Twist Lock NEMA L5-30P Twist Lock Rack Units 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 Isolated circuits on dual-circuit models with separate circuit breakers. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1364 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Electrical Accessories Power Distribution Units Standard Product Single-Phase Vertical-Mount Catalog Number DP1N120615 DP1N160620S DP1N481815 DP1N622415 DP1N622420 DP1N622420T DP1N622420M DP1N622420MT DP1N622040DT DP1E2663030MT Length (in.) 12.00 16.00 48.00 62.00 62.00 62.00 62.00 62.00 62.00 66.00 Length (mm) 305 406 1219 1575 1575 1575 1575 1575 1575 1676 Surge Protection No Yes No No No No No No No No Amp Meter No No No No No No Yes Yes No Yes Load Rating 15A 20A 15A 15A 20A 20A 20A 20A 20A per circuit 30A Voltage (VAC) 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 120 250 Joule Rating — 2000 — — — — — — — — No. of Receptacles 6 6 18 24 24 24 24 24 20, 10 per circuit, dual circuit 30 Receptacle Style NEMA 5-15R NEMA 5-20R NEMA 5-15R NEMA 5-15R NEMA 5-20R NEMA 5-20R NEMA 5-20R NEMA 5-20R NEMA 5-20R 24 IEC C-13, 6 IEC C-19 Power Cord Plug NEMA 5-15P NEMA 5-20P NEMA 5-15P NEMA 5-15P NEMA 5-20P NEMA L5-20P Twist Lock NEMA 5-20P NEMA L5-20P Twist Lock NEMA L5-20P Twist Lock NEMA L6-30P Twist Lock Isolate circuits on dual circuit models with separate circuit breakers. DP1E2663030MT is Ethernet metered; SNMP trap provides remote current monitoring via Ethernet. Standard Product Three-Phase Vertical-Mount Catalog Number DP3E662490T DP3E662490MT DP3E2663635MT Length (in.) 66.00 66.00 66.00 Length (mm) 1676 1676 1676 Amp Meter No Yes Yes Load Rating 30A 30A 35A Voltage (VAC) 208 208 250 No. of Outlets per Phase 8 IEC C-13 and 2 IEC C-19 8 IEC C-13 and 2 IEC C-19 10 IEC C-13, 2 IEC C-19 Total Outlets per PDU 24 IEC C-13 and 6 IEC C-19 24 IEC C-13 and 6 IEC C-19 30 IEC C-13, 6 IEC C-19 Required Inlet Style IEC C-14 and C-20 IEC C-14 and C-20 IEC C-14 and C-20 Power Cord Plug NEMA L21-30P Twist Lock NEMA L21-30P Twist Lock CA style 50A 250 Vac Twist Lock DP3E2663635MT is Ethernet metered; SNMP trap provides remote current monitoring via Ethernet. Rack-Mount PDU Bracket Allows rack-mount power strips to be mounted to cabinet sides without using up rack space. Made of plated steel. Includes two brackets and mounting hardware. Order power strip separately. Bulletin: DPS Catalog Number A19PSMB Finish Plated IEC Cord Sets Pkg. Qty. 2 brackets Cord sets help minimize cord tangle, increasing airflow to equipment. Bulletin: DPS Catalog Number DP5E DP10E Description 0.5-m (1.64-ft.) IEC patch cord. 18/3 SJT Black. C-14 to C-13 1-m (3.28-ft.) IEC patch cord, 18/3 SJT Black. C-14 to C-13 Pkg. Qty. 10 10 IEC C-13 Retaining Clip Secures the IEC C-14 inlet into the C-13 outlet. Helps to prevent inadvertently unplugging the cord set. Catalog Number DPCLIP Description IEC C-13 Retaining Clip Pkg. Qty. 10 Bulletin: DPS CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1365 Accessories: Mounting Accessories Mounting Kits Mounting Accessories Mounting Kits Mounting Bracket Kits Mounting bracket kits are fieldinstallable. Composite kits are rated for 500 lb. (227 kg) maximum load. Kit includes four brackets and mounting hardware for all Type 1 Networking wall-mount and COMLINE® enclosures. DMFK1 and DMFK2 include two 14 gauge steel external mounting brackets and fasteners. Mounting bracket kit CMFK and CMFKSS each contain four 12 gauge steel or Type 304 stainless steel external mounting brackets and fasteners. Sealing washers are provided with each kit to maintain Type 4 or 12 rating after installation. Steel mounting brackets are plated. Catalog Number DMFK1 DMFK2 CMFK CMFKSS CMTGFT Description Mounting bracket kit Mounting bracket kit Steel mounting kit Stainless steel mounting bracket kit Composite mounting bracket kit Bulletin: A80 ULTRX® Mounting Bracket Kit Kit is field-installable. Corrosionresistant fiberglass material. Type 316 stainless steel mounting hardware is included. Four mounting brackets per kit. Catalog Number UUMF Description Mounting Bracket Kit Kit Qty. 4 Bulletin: UX1Y Pole-Mount Kit Use to mount CONCEPT®, Networking and wall-mount enclosures to poles of various sizes and shapes. Simply attach the plated steel channel bar to the mounting holes at the back of the enclosure and wrap the stainless steel strap around the pole and through the bar. Kit includes two mounting channels, two straps suitable for 3-in. (76mm) to 12-in. (305-mm) diameter pole and mounting hardware. Bulletin: CWY Catalog Number CPMK12 CPMK16 CPMK20 CPMK24 CPMK30 Fits Enclosure (in.) when B = 12.00 when B = 16.00 when B = 20.00 when B = 24.00 when B = 30.00 Fits Enclosure (mm) when B = 305 when B = 406 when B = 508 when B = 610 when B = 762 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1366 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Mounting Accessories Mounting Kits Bottom Support Kit Bolt-in bottom support plate with mountng hardware. Coated with ANSI 61 gray polyester powder paint. Required when installing Hoffman floor stands or casters on A17 fiberglass free-standing enclosures. Bulletin: A17Y Catalog Number A17SUPPORT1 A17SUPPORT2 Use With A17 One-Door Fiberglass Enclosures A17 Two-Door Fiberglass Enclosures Unistrut Mounting Kit Bolt-in internal unistrut channel (8 pieces) with mounting hardware. Required to install Hoffman unistrut-mounted free-stand panels and accessories in two-door A17 fiberglass enclosures. Hoffman A17SUPPORT2 plate must also be installed to secure unistrut. Bulletin: A17Y Catalog Number A17UNISTRUT Use With A17 Two-Door Fiberglass Enclosures Enclosure Stabilizers Helps prevent injury to workers by stabilizing floor-mount enclosures which are not bolted down. To install, slip the stabilizer under the floor stand and tighten two thumb screws. Made from .19-in. (5-mm) steel plate. Bright orange finish. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number AENST Description Two stabilizers CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1367 Accessories: Mounting Accessories Mounting Kits Floor Stand Kit Ordering Special heights, depths, materials and finishes can be provided on custom order. Consult factory for information. Bulletin: A4SY, A80 Industry Standards Product maintains UL/CSA Type 4, 4X (stainless steel only) and Type 12 when properly installed on Hoffman Type 4 or Type 12 enclosures. Application Kits are easily installed on most wall-mount Hoffman enclosures. Can also be used to elevate Hoffman free-stand enclosures. To install, drill holes in the bottom of the enclosure and bolt the floor stands to the enclosure.It is not necessary to remove the wall-mount brackets from the enclosure. Specifications 12 gauge steel floor stand has an ANSI 61 gray polyester powder finish over pretreated surfaces. Stainless steel floor stand is Type 304. Components Each kit includes two stands. Two sets of floor stands are recommended for enclosures larger than double door free-stand enclosures. Catalog Number AFK0608 AFK0610 AFK0612 AFK0618 AFK1208 AFK1210 AFK1212 AFK1216 AFK1218 AFK1220 AFK1808 AFK1810 AFK1812 AFK1816 AFK2408 AFK2410 AFK2412 AFK2416 AFK1208SS AFK1210SS AFK1212SS AFK1216SS AFK1218SS AFK1224SS AFK2410SS AFK2412SS Material Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Stainless Steel Height, H (in.) 6.00 6.00 6.00 6.00 12.00 12.00 12.00 12.00 12.00 12.00 18.00 18.00 18.00 18.00 24.00 24.00 24.00 24.00 12.00 12.00 12.00 12.00 12.00 12.00 24.00 24.00 Height, H (mm) 152 152 152 152 305 305 305 305 305 305 457 457 457 457 610 610 610 610 305 305 305 305 305 305 610 610 Width, C (in.) 8.06 10.06 12.06 18.06 8.06 10.06 12.06 16.06 18.13 20.06 8.06 10.06 12.06 16.06 8.06 10.06 12.06 16.06 8.06 10.06 12.06 16.06 18.06 24.06 10.06 12.06 Width, C (mm) 205 256 306 459 205 256 306 408 461 510 205 256 306 408 205 256 306 408 205 256 306 408 459 611 256 306 L (in.) 7.06 7.06 7.06 7.06 8.12 8.12 8.12 8.12 8.12 8.12 9.17 9.17 9.17 9.17 10.23 10.23 10.23 10.23 9.09 9.09 9.09 9.09 9.09 9.09 9.09 9.09 L (mm) 179 179 179 179 206 206 206 206 206 206 233 233 233 233 260 260 260 260 231 231 231 231 231 231 231 231 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1368 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Mounting Accessories Mounting Kits Notes CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1369 Accessories: Mounting Accessories Legs and Casters Plate Casters Legs and Casters Catalog Number DMCKC Description Set of four casters, four mounting plates and hardware Catalog Number PC1M12 Description Set of 4 Casters Plate casters can be used on any enclosure to provide mobility. Casters have dual hard rubber wheels. Each caster has a 350-lb. (159kg) load rating. Caster plates are heavy gauge steel with a zinc plated finish. Casters have ball bearing swivels. A caster kit includes 4 swivel casters and necessary mounting hardware. Catalog number DMCKC caster kit also includes four caster skirts which partially conceal caster plate and mounting hardware. Caster skirts are painted medium gray. Bulletin: D10 Caster Kit A set of four casters (two locking, two non-locking) that mount directly to the bottom of a PROLINE® frame, 0-mm, or 100-mm Solid Base or a Console. (Do not use on plinth bases.) Casters elevate the enclosure 110 mm (4.33 in.) when installed. Caster frames are plated steel with ball-bearing pivots. Caster wheels are made of a black polyamide material. Kit includes M12 mounting hardware. Order separately. Casters Maximum Load: 1000 lb. (453 kg) Exercise care when using casters to move the cabinet. Avoid tipping and damage to the cabinet and its contents by slowly moving the cabinet on its casters across smooth, flat flooring. Avoid: •• large cracks •• floor displacement •• seams •• gravel •• any other obstruction Never use casters while transporting a cabinet by truck on roadways. Contact Hoffman if further information is needed. Bulletin: P20 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1370 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Mounting Accessories Legs and Casters Sanitary Leg Kits Sanitary leg kits provide space between the enclosure and the floor for better washdown accessibility. Available with fixed or independently adjustable legs. Adjustable leg shown. Maintains NEMA Type 4X rating when properly installed on a Hoffman enclosure. Bulletin: WSY Catalog Number WSASLKSS Description Adj. Sanitary Leg kit WSFSLKSS Fixed Sanitary Leg Kit Size L in./mm 11.50-12.50 292-318 12.00 305 Stainless Steel Legs Catalog Number PLEGSS Description (4) Stainless Steel Legs Legs mount to the bottom of a solid base to elevate the enclosure 4 in. (100 mm) from the floor. The legs are made of Type 304 stainless steel and are appropriate for hose-down applications. Mounting hardware is included. Bulletin: P20S CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1371 Accessories: Mounting Accessories Fasteners VELCRO® Cable Wrap Fasteners Securely holds cable to cable manager and unfastens easily for cable maintenance. VELCRO® is 0.5-in. (12.7-mm) wide. Available in 8- and 12-in. (203- and 305-mm) lengths in both screw fastener and wrap styles. M5 self-tapping screw is used on Net Series or PROLINE® frames. VELCRO is a trademark of Velcro Industries B.V. Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number ECWTD8B ECWTD12B ECW8B ECW8R ECW8BL ECW8Y ECW12B ECW12R ECW12BL ECW12Y Description Screw fastener style. Includes M5 mounting screw. Screw fastener style. Includes M5 mounting screw. Wrap style Wrap style Wrap style Wrap style Wrap style Wrap style Wrap style Wrap style L (in.) 8.00 L (mm) 203 Color Black Pkg. Qty. 10 12.00 305 Black 10 8.00 8.00 8.00 8.00 12.00 12.00 12 12 203 203 203 203 305 305 305 305 Black Red Blue Yellow Black Red Blue Yellow 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 Tamper-Resistant Screws Designed for field installation on screw cover pull boxes and screw cover Type 3R enclosures (size 16.00 x 12.00 x 6.00 in. or smaller), consolets, pushbutton enclosures and Type 12 screw cover wiring trough. Each package consists of four Type 18-8 stainless steel screws and four nylon captivating washers. Driver bit must be ordered separately (functions in any handle or socket capable of holding 1/4in. hex insert bits). Bulletin: A80 Description Tamper-resistant screw (10-32) Driver bit Catalog Number ATRSK ATRSDVR Screw Packages Screw Packages are for mounting rack panels and equipment to rack angles. Bulletin: A80, DACCY, X20 Catalog Number ES1224 ES1224250 ES1224B ES1224B250 ASM5 ASM6 ASM5T ASM6250 AS1032 AS1032250 AS1032B Color Silver Silver Black Black Silver Silver Silver Silver Silver Silver Black Pkg. Qty. 4 1 Description 12-24 x 5/8 in. combo head 12-24 x 5/8 in. combo head 12-24 x 5/8in. combo head 12-24 x 5/8 in. combo head M5 x 20 mm Combo Head M6 x 16 mm combo head M5 x 12 mm thread-forming Phillips hex head screws M6 x 16 mm combo head 10-32 x 5/8 in. combo head 10-32 x 5/8 in. combo head 10-32 x 5/8 in. combo head Pkg. Qty. 20 250 20 250 20 20 20 250 20 250 20 Use ASM5T on PROLINE® frame or Net Series extruded holes. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1372 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Mounting Accessories Fasteners Cage Nut Package Cage Nut Packages are for use with square-hole rack angles. Cage nuts are plated steel. Bulletin: DACCY, P20 Clip Nut Package Twenty plated clip nuts fit all rackmounting angles with .281-in. (7-mm) diameter holes (through-hole type). Bulletin: A80, X20 Clamping Nut Package Catalog Number PM5CN PM6CN PM6CN250 P1032CN P1032CN250 P1224CN P1224CN250 Color Silver Silver Silver Silver Silver Silver Silver Description M5 cage nut M6 cage nut M6 cage nut 10-32 cage nut 10-32 cage nut 12-24 cage nut 12-24 cage nut Catalog Number AN1032 ANM5 Description Clip Nut 10-32 Clip Nut M5 (Metric) Pkg. Qty. 20 20 Pkg. Qty. 20 20 250 20 250 20 250 Fits .281-diameter mounting holes .281-diameter mounting holes Twenty plated clamping nuts with top-grip nut retainers. Clamping nuts fit into mounting channels that are used on inside walls of Hoffman enclosures. Clamping nuts are included with all Hoffman accessories that attach to mounting channels. These clamping nuts can be used for mounting other equipment (brackets, etc.) to the enclosure walls. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number APS1032CN APS1420CN APS51618CN Description Package of 20 Package of 20 Package of 20 Catalog Number ASM5T PGFM6 PGFGM6 Description M5 x 12 mm thread-forming Phillips hex head screws Standard Package - M6 cage nuts and bolts Grounding Package - M6 grounding cage nuts and bolts Thread 10-32 1/4-20 5/16-18 PROLINE® Fastener Packages Use to fasten components to the grid system. PGF Packages include 20 front-loading clip nuts (M6) and 20 combination-drive washer-head bolts (M6). Grounding Package is used with the rectangular holes in the PROLINE® frame to provide electrical continuity between the frame and the grid system. ASM5T Package is used with PROLINE frames having round holes. Package includes 20 M5 self-tapping screws. Use in Round holes Rectangular holes Tapped holes Pkg. Qty. 20 20 20 Bulletin: DACCY, P20 Fastener Package Kit includes a set of 8 cage nuts and screws. Used to mount 19-in. rack equipment to 9-mm square holes in uprights. Cage nuts are metric (M6). Screws are pan head Phillips metric M6x16. Catalog Number ECNSM6 Bulletin: DACCY, DEC1 Color Silver Description M6 x 16 pan head posidrive screws. M6 cage nuts. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1373 Accessories: Mounting Accessories Rack-Mount Accessories Guides Rack-Mount Accessories 14 gauge steel chassis guides mount between two pairs of rackmounting angles that have accessory mounting legs. Guides and mounting hardware are plated. (XSFG mount on one pair of Type RA rack-mounting angles that have accessory mounting legs.) Bulletin: P20 Catalog Number AG1U5 AG1U6 AG1U8 Length in./mm 15.00 381.0 21.00 533.4 26.00 660.4 Rack Units 1 1 1 Slides Heavy-duty ball bearing, plated three-section Slides are 16-in. (406mm) long and allow 17-in. (423-mm) extension. They are attached to supports that mount between two pairs of rack-mounting angles that have accessory mounting legs. Mounting hardware is furnished. Equipment 16.75-in. (425-mm) wide can be mounted between Slide assemblies installed on 19-in. rack angles. A pair of Slides can support up to 160 lb. at the extended position when load is distributed evenly along the 16-in. (406-mm) Slide length. Requires Rack Angle Adapter Bracket to fit PROLINE. Needs to be used with the Rack Angle Adapter Bracket (PBRAA, PBRAA19 or PBRAA24). Bulletin: P20 Catalog Number A16SL2U Quantity 2 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1374 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Mounting Accessories Rack-Mount Accessories Fan Speed Control, Rack-Mount Application These Hoffman Fan Speed Controls provide a means to optimize airflow in a cabinet or rack, balancing air volume requirements with noise level and power use. The AFANTSC Panel Mount Fan Speed Control adjusts fan speed automatically based on remote temperature sensor inputs. The A19FANSC 19-in. Rack-Mount Fan Speed Control allows manual control over fan speed. Both units are designed to work with Hoffman 3-, 6- and 10-in. Compact Cooling Fans and with 19-in. fan trays, as well as door- and top-mount fan trays. These fan speed controls are ideal for offices, classrooms and other acoustic noise-sensitive areas. Specifications •• C ontinuously variable fan speed control knob with minimum speed adjustment •• Uses 1 RU rack space •• Steel construction •• Two NEMA 5-15R outlets provide power to fan •• Six-foot (1.83-m) power cord plugs into standard 120V 60 Hz outlet Industry Standards Finish UL 508A Listed; File No. E249700 cUL Listed per CSA C22.2 No. 14; File No. E249700 AFANTSC: Light-gray polycarbonate control housing A19FANSC: RAL 9005 black polyester powder paint Bulletin: DTHRM Description 19-in. Rack-Mount Fan Speed Control Catalog Number A19FANSC Application Fan speed adjusted manually Voltage and Frequency 120V, 60 Hz Current Draw 4A max. Temperature Settings (C) Continously variable Temperature Settings (F) Continously variable Joining Kit Hardware kit to join two open-frame racks. Made of steel with plated finish. Bulletin: DOFRY Catalog Number EJ2DR Description Joining Kit, Side-to-Side Panel Adapter Adapts 23-in. open frame rack to accept 19-in. equipment. Offset provides flush mounting surface. Steel with plated finish. Furnished in pairs. Bulletin: DACCY Catalog Number ERB1U2319 ERB3U2319 ERB5U2319 Rack Units 1 3 5 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1375 Accessories: Mounting Accessories Rack-Mount Accessories Rack Unit Label Self-adhesive clear Mylar™ label with white numbers enables numbering along sides of open frame racks or rack angles. Numbers spaced one rack unit apart. Can be used for bottom-up or top-down numbering of rack units to simplify equipment installation. Each label provided in two pieces (numbers 1-29 and 30-58) for easier installation. Two labels per catalog number. Label shown mounted on rack angle. Mylar is a registered trademark of DuPont Tejin Films. Catalog Number ARULABEL Installed Length in./mm 101.50 2578 Width in./mm .50 13 Bulletin: DOFRY Mobile Base for Open Frame Racks Models for 19-in. 2- and 4-Post Open Frame Racks. Includes four non-locking casters. Will also accept standard levelers. Order catalog number PLM12 separately. The rack mounts on the base to provide greater stability with mobility. Made of steel with RAL 9005 black polyester powder paint finish. Mounting hardware included. Catalog Number A19MB600 A19MB1000 Fits 2-post open-frame racks 4-post open-frame racks with depth adjustable between 17.7- and 29.5-in. (450- and 750-mm) in 0.98-in. (25-mm) increments Bulletin: DOFRY CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1376 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Mounting Accessories Rack-Mount Accessories 19-in. Rack-Mount/Desktop Case, Type 1 Features •• R emovable top and bottom covers attach directly to case framework for maintenance convenience •• Bottom cover has multiple rows of holes for ventilation •• Front bezel includes mounting provisions for 19-in. rack mounting as well as mounting for front panel options for application flexibility •• Top and bottom of framework have mounting provisions for optional support rails for application flexibility. Mounting holes are spaced on 10-mm centers front to back. •• Case framework is assembled for quick installation. Top cover, bottom cover, anti-skid feet and mounting hardware are included. •• Mounting hardware for optional front and rear panels are included with case for installation convenience Industry Standards NEMA Type 1 IEC 60529, IP20 Exterior Dimensions EIA 310-D / IEC 297-1 DIN 41494 Part 1 Specifications Application Desktop cases house circuit boards and other electronic equipment in a rigid framework with easy front and rear access. Rack cases are 19-in. rack mountable with integral mounting provided in the front bezel. •• O ne-piece aluminum die cast front bezel and rear bezel are connected front-to-back with aluminum extrusions to form a rigid structural framework •• Sides on 3U- and 4U-tall cases are the aluminum front-to-back extrusions. The 6U-tall case has two aluminum extrusions with a steel middle panel on each side. •• Covers are 1-mm steel and have grounding provisions Finish Framework has an RAL 7030 stone-gray textured finish. Top and bottom covers have an RAL 7035 light-gray textured finish on the outside and a plated finish on the inside. Bulletin: DEC1 Standard Product Catalog Number ERC3U4837 ERC4U4843 ERC6U4843 AxBxC mm/in. 133 x 483 x 375 5.20 x 19.00 x 14.80 177 x 483 x 435 7.00 x 19.00 x 17.10 266 x 483 x 435 10.50 x 19.00 x 17.10 E mm/in. 131 5.14 175 6.89 264 10.39 F mm/in. 103 4.04 147 5.77 235 9.27 G mm/in. 57 2.25 102 4.00 190 7.50 H mm/in. 110 4.33 155 6.08 243 9.58 Rack Units 3 4 6 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1377 Accessories: Mounting Accessories Rack-Mount Accessories Swing-Out Rack Mounting Frames Full-length 10 gauge swing-out rack mounting frames are available for mounting 19-in. (483-mm) rack mounting equipment. The frame pivots within the enclosure to allow access to the back of the mounted equipment. The frames can be installed in 72.00-in. (1829mm) and 90.00-in. (2286-mm) high enclosures that are 30.00-in. (762mm) or 36.00-in. (914-mm) wide. They can be installed in 60.00-in. (1524-mm) or 72.00-in. (1829-mm) wide enclosures if a center panel support is used. Mounting holes are tapped with #10-32 threads spaced per EIA standard. The design features smooth operation and secure positioning anywhere along the horizontal mounting channels. Frame swings from the left side. All frames are white and furnished with plated mounting hardware. Catalog Number A7230SOF19 A7236SOF19 A9036SOF19 Fits Enclosure Size A x B in./mm 72.06 x 30.06 1830 x 764 72.06 x 36.06 1830 x 916 90.06 x 36.06 2287 x 916 T in./mm 57.88 1470 57.88 1470 75.28 1915 M in./mm 9.09 231 9.09 231 9.34 237 D max in./mm 16.25 413 24.25 616 24.25 616 Number of Units 33 33 43 One unit equals 1.75 inches (44mm). Bulletin: A80 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1378 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Mounting Accessories Rack-Mount Accessories 19-in. and 23-in. Rack Angles Made of 14 gauge steel with square holes or 12 gauge steel with 10-32 tapped holes. Provides 19- or 23-in. rack spacing depending on frame width. Finished with flat black RAL 9005 polyester powder paint or plated. Furnished in pairs. Bulletin: DNCY, DWDH1 Catalog Number ERA197THLN ERA197TPLN ERA1921TPL ERA192321TPL ERA1910TPL Rack Spacing 19 in. 19 in. 19 in. 19 & 23 in. 19 in. Hole Type Square Tapped Tapped Tapped Tapped Finish Black Black Black Black Black Use With Networking Cabinet - SOHO Networking Cabinet - SOHO Seismic Cabinet Seismic Cabinet Network PC Cabinet Fits Frame Height 700mm 700mm 2100mm 2100mm Bottom Section Fits Frame Width 600mm 600mm 700mm 800mm — Rack Units 11 11 45 45 19 L (mm) 492 492 2003 2003 848 L (in.) 19.38 19.38 78.87 78.87 33.37 Rack Mounting Angles - U Style (Type RA) For Free-Stand Enclosures, Type 12 (Bulletin A30), Free-Stand Enclosures, Type 4 (Bulletin A4L) and One-Door Free-Stand Fiberglass Enclosures, Type 4X (Bulletin A17). Pairs of full-length rack mounting angles are available for mounting 19-in. (483-mm) and 24-in. (610-mm) rack-mounted equipment. Type RA rack mounting angles are 14 gauge steel with mounting holes .281 in. (7 mm) in diameter and spaced per EIA standard RS-310-D universal spacing. Use clip nut package AN1032 to provide tapped holes at desired locations. Angles and mounting hardware are plated. All mounting hardware is furnished. Includes two full-length angles. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number A60RA19TH A72RA19TH A72RA24TH A90RA19TH Fits Enclosure AxB in./mm 60.00 x 24.00 60 x 24 72.00 x 24.00 1829 x 610 72.00 x 30.00 1829 x 762 90.00 x 24.00 2286 x 610 K in./mm 3.78 96 3.66 93 3.66 93 3.91 99 L in./mm 49.00 1245 61.25 1556 61.25 1556 78.75 2000 M in./mm 7.78 198 7.66 195 7.66 195 7.91 201 T in./mm 1.95 50 1.95 50 2.45 62 1.95 50 V in./mm 1.89 48 1.89 48 2.39 61 1.89 48 For Rack Size in./mm 19.00 483 19.00 483 24.00 610 19.00 483 Number of Units 28 35 35 45 One unit equals 1.75 inches (44 mm). CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1379 Accessories: Mounting Accessories Rack-Mount Accessories CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1380 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Mounting Accessories Rack-Mount Accessories Rack Mounting Angles - L Style (Type RP) For Free-Stand Enclosures, Type 12 (Bulletin A30), Free-Stand Enclosures, Type 4 (Bulletin A4L) and One-Door Free-Stand Fiberglass Enclosures, Type 4X (Bulletin A17). Pairs of full-length or half-length rack mounting angles are available for mounting 19-in. (483-mm) and 24-in. (610-mm) rack-mounted equipment. Type RP rack mounting angles are 10 gauge steel with mounting holes tapped #10-32 thread and spaced per EIA standard RS-310-D universal spacing. Angles and mounting hardware are plated. All mounting hardware is furnished. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number A60RP24F5 Description Two full-length angles A60RP24F6 Two half-length angles A72RP24F5 Two full-length angles A72RP24F6 Two half-length angles A72RP30F5 Two full-length angles A72RP30F6 Two half-length angles A90RP24F5 Two full-length angles A90RP24F6 Two half-length angles Fits Enclosure AxB in./mm 60.00 x 24.00 1524 x 610 60.00 x 24.00 1524 x 610 72.00 x 24.00 1829 x 610 72.00 x 24.00 1829 x 610 72.00 x 30.00 1829 x 762 72.00 x 30.00 1829 x 762 90.00 x 24.00 2286 x 610 90.00 x 24.00 2286 x 610 For Rack Size in./mm 19.00 483 19.00 483 19.00 483 19.00 483 24.00 610 24.00 610 19.00 483 19.00 483 K in./mm 3.78 96 3.59 91 3.66 93 3.97 101 3.66 93 3.97 101 3.91 99 4.09 104 L in./mm 49.00 1245 26.25 667 61.25 1556 31.50 800 61.25 1556 31.50 800 78.75 2000 40.25 1022 M in./mm 7.78 198 7.59 193 7.66 195 7.97 202 7.66 195 7.97 202 7.91 201 8.09 205 T in./mm 1.94 49 1.94 49 1.94 49 1.94 49 2.44 62 2.44 62 1.94 49 1.94 49 Number of Units 28 15 35 18 35 18 45 23 One unit equals 1.75 inches (44 mm). CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1381 Accessories: Mounting Accessories Rack-Mount Accessories CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1382 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: Mounting Accessories Rack-Mount Accessories Rack Mounting Angle Kit - L Style Designed for mounting 19-in. (483-mm) rack-mount equipment in standard 24-in. (610-mm) wide one-door, wall-mount Type 4 and 12 enclosures. Heavy 10 gauge steel angles are tapped with #10-32 threads spaced to meet EIA RS-310-D. To install, drill small holes in the sides of the enclosure and bolt angles in place. All mounting hardware and instructions are furnished. Sealing washers also are provided to maintain original enclosure standards rating after installation. Rack angles are zinc-plated. External screws are stainless steel. Special sizes, materials and finishes are available on custom order. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number ARAK24 Description Two Angles ARAK30 Two Angles ARAK36 Two Angles For Enclosure Size A x B in./mm 24.00 x 24.00 610 x 610 30.00 x 24.00 762 x 610 36.00 x 24.00 914 x 610 L in./mm 23.75 603 29.75 756 35.75 908 N in./mm 1.62 41 2.00 51 1.50 38 Number of Units 12 15 19 One unit equals 1.75 inches (44 mm). CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1383 Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 Features •• R eady to use •• Frame and door assembly with aluminum back plate included with all models; 120 VAC receptacles and programming connectors are mounted to the plate in 72 standard configurations •• All standard configurations include a GFCI or standard duplex receptacle with a 5-A circuit breaker for added safety •• Door gasket (between the door and plate assemblies) and plate gasket (between the plate assembly and the enclosure) together provide a tight seal •• Template provided for accurate enclosure cutout dimensions •• Quarter-turn latch with screwdriver slot and padlock hasp on all steel and stainless steel door models for convenience and security •• Quarter-turn latch with screwdriver slot on polycarbonate models •• Disk drive enclosure provides access to one or two customersupplied disk drives without opening the cabinet •• Modifications and customization available to accommodate a wide variety of additional connectors Industry Standards Specifications Mild Steel Painted Ports UL 508A Component Recognized; Type 4, 12; File No. E61997 cUL Component Recognized per CSA C22.2 No 94; Type 4, 12; File No. E61997 NEMA/EEMAC Type 4, 12 IEC 60529, IP66 •• D oor assembly and frame manufactured from 16 gauge steel or stainless steel •• Clear-cover models have a molded polycarbonate door •• Steel and stainless steel doors are welded and ground •• Back plate is aluminum Finish Stainless Steel Ports UL 508A Component Recognized; Type 4, 4X, 12; File No. E61997 cUL Component Recognized per CSA C22.2 No 94; Type 4, 4X, 12; File No. E61997 NEMA/EEMAC Type 4, 4X, 12 IEC 60529, IP66 •• R AL 9005 black fine-textured polyester powder coating—mild steel door assemblies •• Brushed finish—stainless steel door assemblies •• Brushed finish—aluminum back plates Modification and Customization Hoffman excels at modifying and customizing products to your specifications. Contact your local Hoffman sales office or distributor for complete information. Clear-Cover (polycarbonate) Ports UL 508A Component Recognized; Type 4X, 12; File No. E61997 cUL Component Recognized per CSA C22.2 No 94; Type 4, 4X, 12; File No. E61997 IEC 60529, IP66 Application INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports are mounted on an enclosure to allow programming access to devices inside without opening the enclosure door. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1384 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Ports for ControlNet Protocol Left-hand image shows front view, GFCI Receptacle Models. Righthand image shows Front front view, Duplex Receptacle Models. Rear view with and without terminal cover are below the table. Bulletin: A70E Catalog Number HGF5CN Material Steel HGF5CNSS Stainless Steel HGF5CNCC Composite HDP5CN Steel HDP5CNSS Stainless Steel HDP5CNCC Composite Configuration - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - Shielded RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - Shielded RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - Shielded RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - Shielded RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - Shielded RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - Shielded RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker Primary Connector/ Termination - Shielded RJ45 - 10-ft. shielded cable with male RJ45 Secondary Connector/ Termination — Supports Devices Sold by the Following Manufacturers Allen-Bradley - Shielded RJ45 - 10-ft. shielded cable with male RJ45 — Allen-Bradley - Shielded RJ45 - 10-ft. shielded cable with male RJ45 — Allen-Bradley - Shielded RJ45 - 10-ft. shielded cable with male RJ45 — Allen-Bradley - Shielded RJ45 - 10-ft. shielded cable with male RJ45 — Allen-Bradley - Shielded RJ45 - 10-ft. shielded cable with male RJ45 — Allen-Bradley CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1385 Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Data Highway Plus Protocol Left-hand image shows front view, GFCI Receptacle Models. Righthand image shows front view, Duplex Receptacle Models. Rear view with and without terminal cover are below the table. Bulletin: A70E Catalog Number HGF58MDH Material Steel HGF58MDHSS Stainless Steel HGF58MDHCC Composite HDP58MDH Steel HDP58MDHSS Stainless Steel HDP58MDHCC Composite Configuration - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - 8-pin mini DIN - DB9F - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - 8-pin mini DIN - DB9F - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - 8-pin mini DIN - DB9F - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - 8-pin mini DIN - DB9F - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - 8-pin mini DIN - DB9F - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - 8-pin mini DIN - DB9F - 5-amp circuit breaker Primary Connector/ Termination Female 8-pin mini DIN Secondary Connector/ Termination DB9F terminal block Supports Devices Sold by the Following Manufacturers Allen-Bradley Female 8-pin mini DIN DB9F terminal block Allen-Bradley Female 8-pin mini DIN DB9F terminal block Allen-Bradley Female 8-pin mini DIN DB9F terminal block Allen-Bradley Female 8-pin mini DIN DB9F terminal block Allen-Bradley Female 8-pin mini DIN DB9F terminal block Allen-Bradley CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1386 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for DeviceNet Protocol Left-hand image shows front view, GFCI Receptacle Models. Righthand image shows front view, Duplex Receptacle Models. Rear view with and without terminal cover are below the table. Bulletin: A70E Catalog Number HGF5DN5P Material Steel HGF5DN5PSS Stainless Steel HGF5DN5PCC Composite HDP5DN5P Steel HDP5DN5PSS Stainless Steel HDP5DN5PCC Composite Configuration - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - 5-pin Phoenix Style - 5-pin mini receptacle - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - 5-pin Phoenix Style - 5-pin mini receptacle - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - 5-pin Phoenix Style - 5-pin mini receptacle - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - 5-pin Phoenix Style - 5-pin mini receptacle - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - 5-pin Phoenix Style - 5-pin mini receptacle - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - 5-pin Phoenix Style - 5-pin mini receptacle - 5-amp circuit breaker Supports Devices Sold by the Following Manufacturers Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc Primary Connector/ Termination 5-pin Phoenix Style terminal block Secondary Connector/ Termination 5-pin mini receptacle terminal block 5-pin Phoenix Style terminal block 5-pin mini receptacle terminal block Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc 5-pin Phoenix Style terminal block 5-pin mini receptacle terminal block Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc 5-pin Phoenix Style terminal block 5-pin mini receptacle terminal block Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc 5-pin Phoenix Style terminal block 5-pin mini receptacle terminal block Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc 5-pin Phoenix Style terminal block 5-pin mini receptacle terminal block Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1387 Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for DH+, ModBus Plus, Ethernet Protocol Left-hand image shows front view, GFCI Receptacle Models. Righthand image shows front view, Duplex Receptacle Models. Rear view with and without terminal cover are below the table. Bulletin: A70E CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Catalog Number HGF5ETHDH Material Steel HGF5ETHDHSS Stainless Steel HGF5ETHDHCC Composite HDP5ETHDH Steel HDP5ETHDHSS Stainless Steel HDP5ETHDHCC Composite 1388 Configuration - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - RJ45 - DB9F - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - RJ45 - DB9F - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - RJ45 - DB9F - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - RJ45 - DB9F - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - RJ45 - DB9F - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - RJ45 - DB9F - 5-amp circuit breaker Subject to change without notice Supports Devices Sold by the Following Manufacturers Allen-Bradley Group Schneider Computer peripherals Primary Connector/ Termination DB9F terminal block Secondary Connector/ Termination - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable with male RJ45 DB9F terminal block - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable with male RJ45 Allen-Bradley Group Schneider Computer peripherals DB9F terminal block - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable with male RJ45 Allen-Bradley Group Schneider Computer peripherals DB9F terminal block - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable with male RJ45 Allen-Bradley Group Schneider Computer peripherals DB9F terminal block - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable with male RJ45 Allen-Bradley Group Schneider Computer peripherals DB9F terminal block - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable with male RJ45 Allen-Bradley Group Schneider Computer peripherals PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Ethernet Protocol Left-hand image shows front view, GFCI Receptacle Models. Righthand image shows front view, Duplex Receptacle Models. Rear view with and without terminal cover are below the table. Bulletin: A70E CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Catalog Number HGF5ETHETH Material Steel HGF5ETHETHSS Stainless Steel HGF5ETHETHCC Composite HDP5ETHETH Steel HDP5ETHETHSS Stainless Steel HDP5ETHETHCC Composite Subject to change without notice Configuration - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - RJ45 - RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - RJ45 - RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - RJ45 - RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - RJ45 - RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - RJ45 - RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - RJ45 - RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker Supports Devices Sold by the Following Manufacturers Computer peripherals Primary Connector/ Termination - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable Secondary Connector/ Termination - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable Computer peripherals - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable Computer peripherals - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable Computer peripherals - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable Computer peripherals - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable Computer peripherals PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1389 Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Ethernet/ProfiNet Protocol Left-hand image shows front view, GFCI Receptacle Models. Righthand image shows front view, Duplex Receptacle Models. Rear view with and without terminal cover are below the table. Bulletin: A70E CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Catalog Number HGF5ETH Material Steel Configuration - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker Configuration - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable Secondary Connector/ Termination --- HGF5ETHSS Stainless Steel - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable --- HGF5ETHCC Composite - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable --- HDP5ETH Steel - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable --- HDP5ETHSS Stainless Steel - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable --- HDP5ETHCC Composite - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - RJ45 - 5-amp circuit breaker - RJ45 - 10-ft. cable --- 1390 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com Supports Devices Sold by the Following Manufacturers Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc Groupe Schneider Siemens Computer peripherals Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc Groupe Schneider Siemens Computer peripherals Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc Groupe Schneider Siemens Computer peripherals Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc Groupe Schneider Siemens Computer peripherals Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc Groupe Schneider Siemens Computer peripherals Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc Groupe Schneider Siemens Computer peripherals © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Genius Protocol Left-hand image shows front view, GFCI Receptacle Models. Righthand image shows front view, Duplex Receptacle Models. Rear view with and without terminal cover are below the table. Bulletin: A70E Catalog Number HGF5GEG Material Steel HGF5GEGSS Stainless Steel HGF5GEGCC Composite HDP5GEG Steel HDP5GEGSS Stainless Steel HDP5GEGCC Composite Configuration - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker Primary Connector/ Termination - DB9M - 10-ft. cable Secondary Connector/ Termination --- Supports Devices Sold by the Following Manufacturers GE Fanuc - DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- GE Fanuc - DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- GE Fanuc - DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- GE Fanuc - DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- GE Fanuc - DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- GE Fanuc CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1391 Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Micro Protocol Left-hand image shows front view, GFCI Receptacle Models. Righthand image shows front view, Duplex Receptacle Models. Rear view with and without terminal cover are below the table. Bulletin: A70E Catalog Number HGF5TMM Material Steel HGF5TMMSS Stainless Steel HGF5TMMCC Composite HDP5TMM Steel HDP5TMMSS Stainless Steel HDP5TMMCC Composite Configuration - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker Primary Connector/ Termination - DB9M - 10-ft. cable Secondary Connector/ Termination --- Supports Devices Sold by the Following Manufacturers Groupe Schneider - DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- Groupe Schneider - DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- Groupe Schneider - DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- Groupe Schneider - DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- Groupe Schneider - DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- Groupe Schneider CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1392 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Modbus Protocol Left-hand image shows front view, GFCI Receptacle Models. Righthand image shows front view, Duplex Receptacle Models. Rear view with and without terminal cover are below the table. Bulletin: A70E Catalog Number HGF5TMB Material Steel HGF5TMBSS Stainless Steel HGF5TMBCC Composite HDP5TMB Steel HDP5TMBSS Stainless Steel HDP5TMBCC Composite Configuration - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - DB9M - 5-amp circuit breaker Primary Connector/ Termination -DB9M - 10-ft. cable Secondary Connector/ Termination --- Supports Devices Sold by the Following Manufacturers Groupe Schneider -DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- Groupe Schneider -DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- Groupe Schneider -DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- Groupe Schneider -DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- Groupe Schneider -DB9M - 10-ft. cable --- Groupe Schneider CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1393 Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for Profibus Protocol Left-hand image shows front view, GFCI Receptacle Models. Righthand image shows front view, Duplex Receptacle Models. Rear view with and without terminal cover are below the table. Bulletin: A70E Catalog Number HGF5PB Material Steel HGF5PBSS Stainless Steel HGF5PBCC Composite HDP5PB Steel HDP5PBSS Stainless Steel HDP5PBCC Composite Configuration - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - 9-pin Profibus - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - 9-pin Profibus - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - 9-pin Profibus - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - 9-pin Profibus - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - 9-pin Profibus - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - 9-pin Profibus - 5-amp circuit breaker Primary Connector/ Termination 9-pin Profibus terminal Secondary Connector/ Termination --- 9-pin Profibus terminal --- 9-pin Profibus terminal --- 9-pin Profibus terminal --- 9-pin Profibus terminal --- 9-pin Profibus terminal --- Supports Devices Sold by the Following Manufacturers Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc Siemens Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc Siemens Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc Siemens Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc Siemens Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc Siemens Allen-Bradley GE Fanuc Siemens CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1394 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for SNP Protocol Left-hand image shows front view, GFCI Receptacle Models. Righthand image shows front view, Duplex Receptacle Models. Rear view with and without terminal cover are below the table. Bulletin: A70E Catalog Number HGF5GESNP Material Steel HGF5GESNPSS Stainless Steel HGF5GESNPCC Composite HDP5GESNP Steel HDP5GESNPSS Stainless Steel HDP5GESNPCC Composite Configuration - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - DB15M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - DB15M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - DB15M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - DB15M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - DB15M - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - DB15M - 5-amp circuit breaker Primary Connector/ Termination - DB15M - 10-ft. cable Secondary Connector/ Termination --- Supports Devices Sold by the Following Manufacturers GE Fanuc - DB15M - 10-ft. cable --- GE Fanuc - DB15M - 10-ft. cable --- GE Fanuc - DB15M - 10-ft. cable --- GE Fanuc - DB15M - 10-ft. cable --- GE Fanuc - DB15M - 10-ft. cable --- GE Fanuc CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1395 Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports for USB Protocol, 10-ft. Cable Left-hand image shows front view, GFCI Receptacle Models. Righthand image shows front view, Duplex Receptacle Models. Rear view with and without terminal cover are below the table. Bulletin: A70E CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Catalog Number HGF5USBUSB Material Steel HGF5USBUSBSS Stainless Steel HGF5USBUSBCC Composite HDP5USBUSB Steel HDP5USBUSBSS Stainless Steel HDP5USBUSBCC Composite 1396 Configuration - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - USB Type A - USB Type A - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - USB Type A - USB Type A - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC GFCI receptacle - USB Type A - USB Type A - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - USB Type A - USB Type A - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - USB Type A - USB Type A - 5-amp circuit breaker - 120 VAC duplex receptacle - USB Type A - USB Type A - 5-amp circuit breaker Subject to change without notice Supports Devices Sold by the Following Manufacturers Computer peripherals Primary Connector/ Termination - USB Type Ab- 10-ft. cable with female USB Type B connector Secondary Connector/ Termination - USB Type A - 10-ft. cable with female USB Type B connector - USB Type A - 10-ft. cable with female USB Type B connector - USB Type A - 10-ft. cable with female USB Type B connector Computer peripherals - USB Type A - 10-ft. cable with female USB Type B connector - USB Type A - 10-ft. cable with female USB Type B connector Computer peripherals - USB Type A - 10-ft. cable with female USB Type B connector - USB Type A - 10-ft. cable with female USB Type B connector Computer peripherals - USB Type A - 10-ft. cable with female USB Type B connector - USB Type A - 10-ft. cable with female USB Type B connector Computer peripherals - USB Type A - 10-ft. cable with female USB Type B connector - USB Type A - 10-ft. cable with female USB Type B connector Computer peripherals PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Type 4/4X/12 Data Interface Port Disk Drive Enclosure Catalog Number HCP514B HCP514BSS Configuration CP2/514b CP2/514b Description Steel 2 gang dual CD/DVD drive cover Stainless steel 2 gang dual CD/DVD drive cover This enclosure, available in both steel and stainless steel, allows access to one or two customer-supplied disk drives from outside the cabinet, allowing computer system use and updates without opening the cabinet. Bulletin: A70E To Order a Modified Configuration for INTERSAFE® Type 4/4X/12 Data Interface Ports •• C hoose the required connectors to a maximum of 8 plate sectors (refer to Plate Sector Diagram) •• Order connectors using the code in the Connector ID column of the INTERSAFE® Connectors table •• Hoffman will determine the layout of the connectors. If a specific layout is required, contact your local Hoffman Sales Office for a quotation. •• 5-amp circuit breakers will be provided with 120VAC receptacles unless otherwise specified •• To order, contact your local Hoffman sales representative Configuration Example Plate Sectors, 8 Maximum Customer Requires (1) 6-pin mini DIN (female) (1) RJ45 connector (female) (1) GFCI duplex receptacle with 3-amp circuit breaker Code MD6 R45 GF3 Sectors Used 1 1 5 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1397 Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Connector 8M Connector Description 8-pin mini DIN Connector Termination Terminal Block Plate Sectors Used 2 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector 9FG Connector Termination 10 ft. cable to male 9-pin D-Sub with bracket Connector Description GE Fanuc Genius 9-pin female with bracket Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector 9FT Connector Description D-Sub 9-pin female Connector Termination 9-pin terminal Plate Sectors Used 2 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector 9M Connector Description D-Sub 9-pin male with cable Connector Termination 10 ft cable to female 9-pin D-Sub Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector 9MT Connector Description D-Sub 9-pin male Connector Termination 9-pin terminal Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1398 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Connector 15F Connector Description D-Sub 15-pin female Connector Termination 10 ft. cable to male 15-pin D-Sub Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector 15FT Connector Description D-Sub 15-pin female with 15-pin terminal Connector Termination 15-pin terminal Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector 15H Connector Description D-Sub 15-pin high density female (Monitor) Connector Termination 10 ft cable to male 15-pin high-density D-Sub Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector 15M Connector Description D-Sub 15-pin male Connector Termination 10-ft. cable to female 15-pin D-Sub Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector 25F Connector Description D-Sub 25-pin female with cable Connector Termination 10 ft. cable to male 25-pin D-Sub Plate Sectors Use 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1399 Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Connector 25FT Connector Description D-Sub 25-pin female with 25-pin terminal Connector Termination 25-pin terminal Plate Sectors Used 2 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector 25M Connector Description D-Sub 25-pin male with cable Connector Termination 10-ft. cable to female 25-pin D-Sub Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector 25MT Connector Description D-Sub 25-pin male Connector Termination 25-pin terminal Plate Sectors Used 2 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector BNC Connector Description BNC Connector Termination BNC female receptacle with 10-ft. cable to male BNC Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector CN Connector Description ControlNet shielded RJ45 female connector Connector Termination 10-ft. shielded cable with male RJ45 Plate Sectors Used 2 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1400 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Connector DH Connector Description Data Highway Plus DB9F Connector Termination Terminal block Plate Sectors Used 2 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector DNM Connector Description DeviceNet Mini Connector Termination Terminal block Plate Sectors Used 2 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector DNP Connector Description DeviceNet Phoenix Connector Termination Terminal block Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector DPO Connector Description Duplex receptacle with no circuit breaker Connector Termination Terminal block Plate Sectors Used 4 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1401 Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Connector DP3 Connector Description Duplex receptacle with 3-amp circuit breaker Connector Termination Terminal block Plate Sectors Used 5 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector DP5 Connector Description Duplex receptacle with 5-amp circuit breaker Connector Termination Terminal block Plate Sectors Used 5 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector ETH Connector Description RJ45 female connector Connector Termination 10-ft. cable with male RJ45 Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector GEG Connector Description DB9 GE Genius Connector Termination 10-ft. cable Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1402 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Connector GFO Connector Description GFCI receptacle Connector Termination Terminal block Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector GF3 Connector Description GFCI receptacle with 3-amp circuit breaker Connector Termination Terminal block Plate Sectors Used 5 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector GF5 Connector Description GFCI receptacle with 5-amp circuit breaker Connector Termination Terminal block Plate Sectors Used 5 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1403 Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Connector MCL Connector Description Micrologix Connector Termination 10-ft. cable Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector MCL8 Connector Description Micrologix Connector Termination 10-ft. cable Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector MD6 Connector Description 6-pin mini DIN (female) Connector Termination 10-ft. cable with female 6-pin mini DIN Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector MD8 Connector Description 8-pin mini DIN (female) Connector Termination 10-ft. cable with male 8-pin mini DIN Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1404 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Connector PB Connector Description ProfiBus 9-pin Connector Termination Terminal Plate Sectors Used 2 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector R11 Connector Description RJ11 female connector with male RJ12 Connector Termination 10-ft. cable with male RJ12 Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector RJS Connector Description RJ45 shielded female connector Connector Termination 10-ft. shielded cable with male RJ45 Plate Sectors Used 2 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector SNP Connector Description DB15F GESNP Connector Termination DB15 male GESNP with 10-ft. cable Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1405 Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Connector SPO Connector Description Single receptacle with no circuit breaker Connector Termination Terminal block with terminal cover Plate Sectors Used 2 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector SP3 Connector Description Single receptacle with 3-amp circuit breaker Connector Termination Terminal block with terminal cover Plate Sectors Used 2 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector SP5 Connector Description Single receptacle with 5-amp circuit breaker Connector Termination Terminal block with terminal cover Plate Sectors Used 2 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector TMB Connector Description DB9F Modbus Connector Termination 10-ft. cable Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1406 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports INTERSAFE® Data Interface Ports, Type 4/4X/12 INTERSAFE® Connector TMM Connector Description DB9F Micro Connector Termination 10-ft. cable Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. INTERSAFE® Connector USB Connector Description USB Type A, female input Connector Termination 10-ft. cable, USB Type B connector Plate Sectors Used 1 Left-hand image shows front view. Right-hand image shows rear view. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1407 Accessories: EMC Accessories EMC Accessories EMC Accessories EMC Accessories Bonding Cable Clamps These cable clamps are used when securing cables. They provide the conductivity required to ground the shielding on EMC-shielded cable. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number ABCC6 ABCC95 ABCC125 ABCC19 Max. Cable Diameter (in.) 0.25 0.38 0.50 0.75 EMC Cable Strain Reliefs These cable strain reliefs have provisions for grounding the EMC shielding of cables entering an enclosure while maintaining a NEMA Type 4 seal. Bulletin: A80 Bonding Straps Catalog Number ACSR4EMC Size PG9 ACSR6EMC PG11 ACSR10EMC PG16 ACSR14EMC PG16 ACSR17EMC PG21 ACSR19EMC PG29 ACSR22EMC PG29 ACSR25EMC PG36 ACSR29EMC PG36 Max. Cable Diameter (mm) 6 10 13 19 Cable Diameter mm/in. 4-6 0.16 - 0.24 6 - 10 0.24 - 0.39 10 - 14 0.39 - 0.55 14 - 17 0.55 - 0.67 17 - 20 0.67 - 0.79 19 - 23 0.75 - 0.91 22 - 27 0.87 - 1.06 25 - 30 0.98 - 1.18 29 - 32 1.14 - 1.26 Hole Diameter mm/in. 16 0.63 19 0.75 23 0.91 23 0.91 29 1.14 38 1.50 38 1.50 48 1.89 48 1.89 Bonding straps assist in maintaining a constant voltage potential across a ground plane. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number ABS6 ABS12 ABS18 Length mm/in. 152 6.00 305 12.00 457 18.00 Package Quantity 3 3 3 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1408 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: EMC Accessories EMC Accessories Notes CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1409 Accessories: INLINE® Accessories INLINE® Accessories INLINE® Panels INLINE® Accessories INLINE® Accessories Panels are 12 gauge steel with a white polyester powder paint or conductive finish. Ground hole is labeled. Sized for M6 fastener. Bulletin: A53, A54P Catalog Number LP1515 LP1515G LP2015 LP2015G LP2520 LP2520G LP3025 LP3025G LP3530 LP3530G LP2040 LP2040G LP2060 LP2060G Panel Size D x E (mm) 131 x 131 131 x 131 181 x 131 181 x 131 231 x 181 231 x 181 281 x 231 281 x 231 331 x 281 331 x 281 181 x 381 181 x 381 181 x 581 181 x 581 Material Painted Steel Conductive Painted Steel Conductive Painted Steel Conductive Painted Steel Conductive Painted Steel Conductive Painted Steel Conductive Painted Steel Conductive Panel Size D x E (in.) 5.16 x 5.16 5.16 x 5.16 7.13 x 5.16 7.13 x 5.16 9.10 x 7.13 9.10 x 7.13 11.07 x 9.10 11.07 x 9.10 13.04 x 11.07 13.04 x 11.07 7.13 x 15.01 7.13 x 15.01 7.13 x 22.89 7.13 x 22.89 Fits INLINE Enclosure Size (mm) 150 x 150 150 x 150 200 x 150 200 x 150 250 x 200 250 x 200 300 x 250 300 x 250 350 x 300 350 x 300 200 x 400 200 x 400 200 x 600 200 x 600 INLINE® Landscape Panels Panels are 12 gauge steel with a white polyester powder paint or conductive finish. They include a labeled ground hole sized for an M6 screw. Panels mount on studs provided in the enclosure or to optional DIN mounting brackets. Bulletin: A54P Catalog Number LP2331 LP2346 LP2360 LP2377 LP2393 Conductive Panel LP2331G LP2346G LP2360G LP2377G LP2393G Panel Size D x E (mm) 211 x 291 211 x 441 211 x 581 211 x 751 211 x 906 Panel Size D x E (in.) 8.31 x 11.46 8.31 x 17.36 8.31 x 22.87 8.31 x 29.57 8.31 x 35.67 Mounting-Bracket Kit Kit is field-installable on all solid-back-body enclosures. Hardware included. Four brackets per kit. Bulletin: A54SY, A54Y Lock Inserts Lock Inserts can replace the standard slotted quarter-turn latch. Inserts have chrome finish. Key included. Bulletin: A54Y Catalog Number LMFK LMFKSS Description Plated steel mounting-bracket kit Type 316L stainless steel mounting-bracket kit Catalog Number LLKSM7 LLKSM8 LLKDB LLKDBM3 LLKSS Description Square 7 mm Square 8 mm Daimler Benz Double bit 3 mm Slotted screw CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1410 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: INLINE® Accessories INLINE® Accessories Wing Knob Latch Wing Knob Latch can replace the standard slotted, quarter-turn latch on all hinged-cover and windowcover enclosures. Latch is black die-cast zinc. Includes two keys and installation instructions. Reduces UL Type rating from 4 or 4X to 12. Catalog Number LLKWK Product Weight 0.2 lb. Bulletin: A54Y Grounding Kit Grounding Kit provides means to attach a grounding conductor to the enclosure. Kit includes two insulated copper wires with a ring terminal at each end, all installation hardware and instructions. Bulletin: A54Y Catalog Number LLGK DIN3 Type Rails Rails furnish mounting surfaces for DIN3 mount snap-on devices. Rails attach vertically or horizontally to mounting brackets. Kit includes 4 rails and installation instructions. DIN3 Rail Mounting Brackets are required in order to mount rails. Bulletin: A54Y Catalog Number LDR3P15 LDR3P20 LDR3P25 LDR3P30 LDR3P31 LDR3P35 LDR3P40 LDR3P46 LDR3P60 LDR3P77 LDR3P93 Product Weight 0.2 lb. Fits INLINE Enclosure when A or B = 150 mm when A or B = 200 mm when A or B = 250 mm when A or B = 300 mm when A or B = 310 mm when A or B = 350 mm when A or B = 400 mm when A or B = 460 mm when A or B = 600 mm when A or B = 770 mm when A or B = 925 mm L (mm) 125 175 225 275 285 325 375 435 575 745 900 L (in.) 4.92 6.89 8.86 10.83 11.22 12.80 14.76 17.13 22.64 29.33 36.43 Pkg. Qty. 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 DIN Rail or Panel-Mounting Brackets Use as a mounting framework to install DIN rails or a panel. Bracket is offset for additional space in front of or behind mounted equipment. Plated 12 gauge steel. Mounting hardware included. Brackets are required for DIN3 type rails. Bulletin: A54Y Catalog Number LMK15 LMK20 LMK23 LMK25 LMK30 LMK35 Fits INLINE Enclosure when A or B = 150 mm when A or B = 200 mm when A or B = 230 mm when A or B = 250 mm when A or B = 300 mm when A or B = 350 mm 600-mm and longer enclosures require two sets of brackets for mounting panels. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1411 Accessories: CONCEPT® Accessories CONCEPT® Accessories CONCEPT® Panel Conversion Kit CONCEPT® Accessories CONCEPT® Accessories Panel Conversion Kit adapts enclosure for mounting standard NEMAstyle panels in CONCEPT® enclosures. Bracket attaches to rear collar stud. Kit includes four adapter plates and hardware for mounting panel. Bulletin: CWY Catalog Number CCPM4 Swing-Out Rack Frame Material Steel Fits CONCEPT Enclosure When A x B is equal to or less than 30.00 x 30.00 in. (762 x 762 mm) Swing-Out Rack Frames provide 120-degree swing-out access for 19-in. rack equipment. Welded rack frame mounts to front flange. Distance from frame to door surface is 1.32 in. (33 mm) for solid doors and 1.07 in. (27 mm) for window doors. Frame is painted steel ANSI 61 gray. Mounting hinge and latching hardware provided. Order separately clip nut package catalog number XNM5 and screws XSM5 (metric) or AN1032 and screws AS1032 (English). Swing-Out Rack Frame cannot be mounted on adjustable mounting kit. Bulletin: CWY Catalog Number CSF2424 CSF3024 CSF3624 Pole-Mount Kit Material Painted steel Painted steel Painted steel Fits Enclosure A x B 24.00 x 24.00 in. (610 x 610 mm) 30.00 x 24.00 in. (762 x 610 mm) 36.00 x 24.00 in. (914 x 610 mm) Use to mount CONCEPT®, Networking and wall-mount enclosures to poles of various sizes and shapes. Simply attach the plated steel channel bar to the mounting holes at the back of the enclosure and wrap the stainless steel strap around the pole and through the bar. Kit includes two mounting channels, two straps suitable for 3-in. (76mm) to 12-in. (305-mm) diameter pole and mounting hardware. Bulletin: CWY Catalog Number CPMK12 CPMK16 CPMK20 CPMK24 CPMK30 Mounting Channels Fits Enclosure (in.) when B = 12.00 when B = 16.00 when B = 20.00 when B = 24.00 when B = 30.00 Fits Enclosure (mm) when B = 305 when B = 406 when B = 508 when B = 610 when B = 762 Mounting Channels provide mounting framework for installing DIN rails and grid straps at various positions within the enclosure. Channels can be mounted vertically or horizontally to collar studs or to the slide mechanisms of the adjustable-depth mounting kit. Kit includes two channels. Bulletin: CWY Catalog Number CMC12 CMC16 CMC20 CMC24 CMC60 Fits CONCEPT Enclosure when A or B = 12.00 in. (305 mm) when A or B = 16.00 in. (406 mm) when A or B = 20.00 in. (508 mm) when A or B = 24.00 in. (610 mm) when A or B = 60.00 in. (1524 mm) CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1412 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: CONCEPT® Accessories CONCEPT® Accessories Rack-Mount Angles Rack-Mount Angles are a mounting means for 19-in. rack equipment in 24-in. wide enclosures. L-shaped through-hole angles attach to enclosure flange or the adjustable-depth mounting kit. Holes are .281 in. (7 mm) in diameter. Clear plated 14 gauge steel construction. Mounting hardware included. Order separately clip nut package catalog number XNM5 and screws XSM5 (metric) or AN1032 and screws AS1032 (English). Bulletin: CWY Catalog Number CRA12TH CRA16TH DIN3 Rail Kits Fits CONCEPT Enclosure when A = 24.00 in. (610 mm) when A = 30.00 in. (762 mm) Rack Units 12 16 DIN3 Rail Kits supply mounting surfaces for DIN mount snap-on devices in either DIN 1, DIN 3 or CENELEC styles. Rails attach vertically or horizontally to rear collar stud or to mounting channels. Kit includes three rails and mounting hardware. Bulletin: CWY Catalog Number CDR3P12 CDR3P16 CDR3P20 CDR3P24 Fits CONCEPT Enclosure when A or B = 12.00 in. (305 mm) when A or B = 16.00 in. (406 mm) when A or B = 20.00 in. (508 mm) when A or B = 24.00 in. (610 mm) CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1413 Accessories: CONCEPT® Accessories CONCEPT® Accessories CONCEPT® Panels These panels are taller and wider than corresponding NEMA-size panels. Panels are 14 or 12 gauge steel and painted white or have a conductive finish. Panels have a formed flange along any side that is longer than 22.20 in. (564 mm). CP2420 and CP2424 have a flange on all four sides. Bulletin: CWP, CWY Catalog Number CP1212 CP1212G CP1612 CP1612G CP1616 CP1616G CP2016 CP2016G CP2014 CP2014G CP2416 CP2416G CP2020 CP2020G CP2420 CP2420G CP3020 CP3020G CP2424 CP2424G CP3024 CP3024G CP3624 CP3624G CP4824 CP4824G CP3030 CP3030G CP3630 CP3630G CP4230 CP4230G CP3636 CP3636G CP4236 CP4236G CP4836 CP4836G CP6036 CP6036G CP2442 CP2442G CP3048 CP3048G CP3060 CP3060G CP7236 Panel Type Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Conductive Painted steel Panel Size D x E (in.) 10.20 x 10.20 10.20 x 10.20 14.20 x 10.20 14.20 x 10.20 14.20 x 14.20 14.20 x 14.20 18.20 x 14.20 18.20 x 14.20 18.20 x 12.20 18.20 x 14.20 22.20 x 14.20 22.20 x 14.20 18.20 x 18.20 18.20 x 18.20 22.20 x 18.20 22.20 x 18.20 28.20 x 18.20 28.20 x 18.20 22.20 x 22.20 22.20 x 22.20 28.20 x 22.20 28.20 x 22.20 34.20 x 22.20 34.20 x 22.20 46.20 x 22.20 46.20 x 22.20 28.20 x 28.20 28.20 x 28.20 34.20 x 28.20 34.20 x 28.20 40.20 x 28.20 40.20 x 28.20 34.20 x 34.20 34.20 x 34.20 40.20 x 34.20 40.20 x 34.20 46.20 x 34.20 46.20 x 34.20 58.20 x 34.20 58.20 x 34.20 22.20 x 40.20 22.20 x 40.20 28.20 x 46.20 28.20 x 46.20 28.20 x 58.20 28.20 x 58.20 70.20 x 34.20 Panel Size D x E (mm) 259 x 259 259 x 259 361 x 259 361 x 259 361 x 361 361 x 361 462 x 361 462 x 361 462 x 310 462 x 310 564 x 361 564 x 361 462 x 462 462 x 462 564 x 462 564 x 462 716 x 462 716 x 462 564 x 564 564 x 564 716 x 564 716 x 564 869 x 564 869 x 564 1173 x 564 1173 x 564 716 x 716 716 x 716 869 x 716 869 x 716 1021 x 716 1021 x 716 869 x 869 869 x 869 1021 x 869 1021 x 869 1173 x 869 1173 x 869 1478 x 869 1478 x 869 564 x 1021 564 x 1021 716 x 1173 716 x 1173 716 x 1478 716 x 1478 1783 x 869 Gauge 14 14 14 14 12 12 12 12 14 14 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 Catalog number CP4230 is used on CONCEPT disconnect enclosures. CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1414 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: CONCEPT® Accessories CONCEPT® Accessories CONCEPT® Swing-Out Panels CSPB Panels Catalog Number CSPB1212 CSPB1612 CSPB1616 CSPB1620 CSPB2016 CSPB2020 CSPB2024 CSPB2416 CSPB2420 CSPB2424 CSPB2430 CSPB3020 CSPB3024 CSPB3030 CSPB3624 CSPB3630 CSPB3636 CSPB4236 CSPB4824 CSPB4836 CSPB6036 Panels swing clear from the front of the enclosure to provide access to mounted internal equipment. For CSPB panels, maximum swing is 94 degrees. For CSP panels, maximum panel swing is 106 degrees. Distance from panel surface to door when in the latched position is 1.71 in. (43 mm) for solid doors and 1.45 in. (37 mm) for window doors. Kits include panel, brackets and hardware to mount to the front flange. Swing-out panels also can be mounted on front-to-back adjustable rails. CSPB panels require adapter CSPBADB and front-to-back adjustable rails for front-to-back adjustment. Bulletin: CWY CONCEPT® Adapter Bracket Adapter bracket for use with CONCEPT® B-style Swing-Out Panels and Adjustable-Depth Mounting Kits. Bracket enables the B-style swing-out panels to be mounted in infinite front-to-back positions within a CONCEPT enclosure. Handles Fits Enclosure Size (in.) 12.00 x 12.00 16.00 x 12.00 16.00 x 16.00 16.00 x 20.00 20.00 x 16.00 20.00 x 20.00 20.00 x 24.00 24.00 x 16.00 24.00 x 20.00 24.00 x 24.00 24.00 x 30.00 30.00 x 20.00 30.00 x 24.00 30.00 x 30.00 36.00 x 24.00 36.00 x 30.00 36.00 x 36.00 42.00 x 36.00 48.00 x 24.00 48.00 x 36.00 60.00 x 36.00 Fits Enclosure Size (mm) 305 x 305 406 x 305 406 x 406 406 x 508 508 x 406 508 x 508 508 x 610 610 x 406 610 x 508 610 x 610 610 x 762 762 x 508 762 x 610 762 x 762 914 x 610 914 x 762 914 x 914 1067 x 914 1219 x 610 1219 x 914 1542 x 914 Panel Size (in.) 9.72 x 9.75 13.72 x 9.75 13.72 x 13.75 13.72 x 17.75 17.72 x 13.75 17.72 x 17.75 17.72 x 21.75 21.72 x 13.73 21.72 x 17.75 21.72 x 21.75 21.72 x 27.75 27.72 x 17.75 27.72 x 21.75 27.72 x 27.75 33.72 x 21.75 33.72 x 27.75 33.72 x 33.75 39.72 x 33.75 45.72 x 21.75 45.72 x 33.75 57.72 x 33.75 Panel Size (mm) 247 x 248 349 x 248 349 x 349 349 x 451 450 x 349 450 x 451 450 x 553 552 x 349 552.452 552 x 553 552 x 705 704 x 451 704 x 553 704 x 705 857 x 553 857 x 705 857 x 857 1009 x 857 1161 x 553 1161 x 857 1466 x 857 CSP Panels Catalog Number CSP1212 CSP1612 CSP1616 CSP1620 CSP2016 CSP2020 CSP2024 CSP2416 CSP2420 CSP2424 CSP3020 CSP3024 CSP3030 CSP3624 CSP3630 CSP3636 Fits Enclosure (in.) 12.00 x 12.00 16.00 x 12.00 16.00 x 16.00 16.00 x 20.00 20.00 x 16.00 20.00 x 20.00 20.00 x 24.00 24.00 x 16.00 24.00 x 20.00 24.00 x 24.00 30.00 x 20.00 30.00 x 24.00 30.00 x 30.00 36.00 x 24.00 36.00 x 30.00 36.00 x 36.00 Fits Enclosure (mm) 305 x 305 406 x 305 406 x 406 406 x 508 508 x 406 508 x 508 508 x 610 610 x 406 610 x 508 610 x 610 762 x 508 762 x 610 762 x 762 914 x 610 914 x 762 914 x 914 Panel Size (in.) 9.78 x 9.84 13.78 x 9.84 13.78 x 13.84 13.78 x 17.84 17.78 x 13.84 17.78 x 17.84 17.78 x 21.84 21.78 x 13.84 21.78 x 17.84 21.78 x 21.84 27.78 x 17.84 27.78 x 21.84 27.78 x 27.84 33.78 x 21.84 33.78 x 27.84 33.78 x 33.84 Panel Size (mm) 248 x 250 350 x 250 350 x 352 350 x 453 452 x 352 452 x 453 452 x 555 553 x 352 553 x 453 553 x 555 706 x 453 706 x 555 706 x 707 858 x 555 858 x 707 858 x 860 Bulletin: CWY Catalog Number CSPBADB Material Steel Handles can replace the standard slotted insert on all CONCEPT® wall-mount enclosures. The CONCEPT non-locking handle provides quick and easy access to the enclosure contents. Handle is black plastic. A zinc die-cast keylock handle is available for applications requiring quick access and security. A padlocking handle, also zinc die-cast, accommodates a padlock with up to a 5/16-in. locking bar. Each latch system can be converted from clockwise to counterclockwise opening. Kit includes all hardware. Bulletin: CWY Catalog Number CWHK CWHNL CWHPTO UL Rating Maintains UL/CSA Type 12 when properly installed Maintains UL Type 3, 4, 4X, 12 when properly installed Maintains UL/CSA Type 3, 4, 12 when properly installed Description Keylock handle Non-locking handle Padlock handle CWHNL is not suitable for 3-point latch operation. CHS Controls AB Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1415 Accessories: CONCEPT® Accessories CONCEPT® Accessories Door Stop Kit Door Stop Kit secures the door in the open position. Kit can be installed at the top or bottom of a door which opens horizontally. Door opening angle can be easily adjusted by means of a wing nut. Stop arm slides neatly out of the way when the door is closed. All parts are plated. Mounting hardware included. •• Door stop kits should not be installed on enclosures configured with a swing-out panel or swing-out rack frame •• Door stop kits cannot be used with CONCEPT window doors Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number ADSTOPK Data Pockets Finish Plated Steel Data Pockets provide convenient storage for wiring diagrams, operation manuals and other documentation inside an enclosure. Pocket mounts on studs located on the inside of a solid-door enclosure. Constructed of high-impact thermoplastic, pockets are dark gray and have cutout areas for easy access and visibility to contents. Mounting hardware included. Bulletin: UX1Y Catalog Number ADP1 ADP2 Length x Width in./mm 6.00 x 6.00 152 x 152 12.00 x 12.00 305 x 305 Fits CONCEPT Enclosure when A is less than or equal to 24 and B is less than or equal to 24 when A is greater than or equal to 30 and B is greater than or equal to 20 Use ADP2 when A = 24 and B = 30 Lock Inserts Lock inserts can be substituted for the standard 3-mm double-bit latch insert. Inserts have a chrome finish. Matching key is zinc diecast. Bulletin: A4GY, CWY Catalog Number CLKTM7 CLKSM7 CLKDBM3 CLKSLOT Mounting-Bracket Kits Description Triangular 7-mm insert with key Square 7-mm insert with key Double bit with key Slotted Insert no key Mounting-Bracket Kits are field installable. Composite and stainless steel brackets are rated to Type 4X. Set of four (4) brackets can support 500 lb. maximum load. All hardware is included. Four brackets per kit. Mounting brackets are required to maintain UL/CSA external mounting requirement. Bulletin: A80 Catalog Number CMFK CMFKSS CMTGFT Description Steel Stainless Steel Composite CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se 1416 Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products Accessories: CONCEPT® Accessories CONCEPT® Accessories Hinge Pins Contact Customer Service to order new mild steel hinge pins for an existing product. Bulletin: VM3 Catalog Number GHPINMS Door Bars Description Hinge Pin Qty. 2 Non-metallic door bar includes pressure-sensitive tape adhesive. Bulletin: CWY Catalog Number ADB305MM Description Door Bar Length 8 in. (203 mm) Qty. 4 CHS Controls AB Florettgatan 33 SE-254 67 Helsingborg, Sweden Tel +46 42 38 61 00, Fax +46 42 38 61 29 chs@chscontrols.se www.chscontrols.se Subject to change without notice PH (763) 422-2211 • FX (763) 422-2600 • hoffmanonline.com © 2011 Pentair Technical Products 1417
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.4 Linearized : Yes Author : Pentair Technical Products Create Date : 2011:05:17 14:57:46-05:00 Keywords : Condensation and Pressure Compensation; Panels and Panel Accessories; Window Kits; Door Accessories; Shelves, Keyboard Trays and Gland Plates; Locks, Lockouts, Latches, Handles and Clamps; Drip Shields; Hole Seals; Corrosion Inhibitors; Electrical Accessories; Mounting Accessories; INTERSAFE Date Interface Ports; EMC Accessories; INLINE Accessories; CONCEPT Accessories Modify Date : 2011:10:20 14:50:30+02:00 XMP Toolkit : Adobe XMP Core 4.2.1-c043 52.372728, 2009/01/18-15:08:04 Producer : Adobe PDF Library 9.0 Trapped : False Creator Tool : Adobe InDesign CS4 (6.0.6) Metadata Date : 2011:10:20 14:50:30+02:00 Format : application/pdf Title : Specifiers Guide Chapter 14: Accessories Creator : Pentair Technical Products Document ID : uuid:ce67a93a-4586-459e-85aa-a961db39a395 Instance ID : uuid:bac90819-7bbe-464b-abd1-f44406ac8ec7 Page Layout : OneColumn Page Count : 132EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools